annotate runtime/doc/syntax.txt @ 3967:fdb8a9c7bd91

Updated runtime files.
author Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
date Wed, 28 Nov 2012 18:21:11 +0100
parents c53344bacabf
children e362db8b2d7b
Ignore whitespace changes - Everywhere: Within whitespace: At end of lines:
rev   line source
3967
fdb8a9c7bd91 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
1 *syntax.txt* For Vim version 7.3. Last change: 2012 Nov 28
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
6
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
7 Syntax highlighting *syntax* *syntax-highlighting* *coloring*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
9 Syntax highlighting enables Vim to show parts of the text in another font or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
10 color. Those parts can be specific keywords or text matching a pattern. Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
11 doesn't parse the whole file (to keep it fast), so the highlighting has its
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
12 limitations. Lexical highlighting might be a better name, but since everybody
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
13 calls it syntax highlighting we'll stick with that.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
14
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
15 Vim supports syntax highlighting on all terminals. But since most ordinary
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
16 terminals have very limited highlighting possibilities, it works best in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
17 GUI version, gvim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
18
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
19 In the User Manual:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
20 |usr_06.txt| introduces syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
21 |usr_44.txt| introduces writing a syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
22
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
23 1. Quick start |:syn-qstart|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
24 2. Syntax files |:syn-files|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
25 3. Syntax loading procedure |syntax-loading|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
26 4. Syntax file remarks |:syn-file-remarks|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
27 5. Defining a syntax |:syn-define|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
28 6. :syntax arguments |:syn-arguments|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
29 7. Syntax patterns |:syn-pattern|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
30 8. Syntax clusters |:syn-cluster|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
31 9. Including syntax files |:syn-include|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
32 10. Synchronizing |:syn-sync|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
33 11. Listing syntax items |:syntax|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
34 12. Highlight command |:highlight|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
35 13. Linking groups |:highlight-link|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
36 14. Cleaning up |:syn-clear|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
37 15. Highlighting tags |tag-highlight|
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
38 16. Window-local syntax |:ownsyntax|
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
39 17. Color xterms |xterm-color|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
40
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
41 {Vi does not have any of these commands}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
42
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
43 Syntax highlighting is not available when the |+syntax| feature has been
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
44 disabled at compile time.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
45
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
46 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
47 1. Quick start *:syn-qstart*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
48
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
49 *:syn-enable* *:syntax-enable*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
50 This command switches on syntax highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
51
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
52 :syntax enable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
53
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
54 What this command actually does is to execute the command >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
55 :source $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
56
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
57 If the VIM environment variable is not set, Vim will try to find
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
58 the path in another way (see |$VIMRUNTIME|). Usually this works just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
59 fine. If it doesn't, try setting the VIM environment variable to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
60 directory where the Vim stuff is located. For example, if your syntax files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
61 are in the "/usr/vim/vim50/syntax" directory, set $VIMRUNTIME to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
62 "/usr/vim/vim50". You must do this in the shell, before starting Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
63
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
64 *:syn-on* *:syntax-on*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
65 The ":syntax enable" command will keep your current color settings. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
66 allows using ":highlight" commands to set your preferred colors before or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
67 after using this command. If you want Vim to overrule your settings with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
68 defaults, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
69 :syntax on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
70 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
71 *:hi-normal* *:highlight-normal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
72 If you are running in the GUI, you can get white text on a black background
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
73 with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
74 :highlight Normal guibg=Black guifg=White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
75 For a color terminal see |:hi-normal-cterm|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
76 For setting up your own colors syntax highlighting see |syncolor|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
77
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
78 NOTE: The syntax files on MS-DOS and Windows have lines that end in <CR><NL>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
79 The files for Unix end in <NL>. This means you should use the right type of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
80 file for your system. Although on MS-DOS and Windows the right format is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
81 automatically selected if the 'fileformats' option is not empty.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
82
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
83 NOTE: When using reverse video ("gvim -fg white -bg black"), the default value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
84 of 'background' will not be set until the GUI window is opened, which is after
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
85 reading the |gvimrc|. This will cause the wrong default highlighting to be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
86 used. To set the default value of 'background' before switching on
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
87 highlighting, include the ":gui" command in the |gvimrc|: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
88
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
89 :gui " open window and set default for 'background'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
90 :syntax on " start highlighting, use 'background' to set colors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
91
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
92 NOTE: Using ":gui" in the |gvimrc| means that "gvim -f" won't start in the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
93 foreground! Use ":gui -f" then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
94
2520
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
95 *g:syntax_on*
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
96 You can toggle the syntax on/off with this command: >
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
97 :if exists("g:syntax_on") | syntax off | else | syntax enable | endif
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
98
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
99 To put this into a mapping, you can use: >
2520
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
100 :map <F7> :if exists("g:syntax_on") <Bar>
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
101 \ syntax off <Bar>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
102 \ else <Bar>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
103 \ syntax enable <Bar>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
104 \ endif <CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
105 [using the |<>| notation, type this literally]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
106
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
107 Details:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
108 The ":syntax" commands are implemented by sourcing a file. To see exactly how
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
109 this works, look in the file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
110 command file ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
111 :syntax enable $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
112 :syntax on $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
113 :syntax manual $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/manual.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
114 :syntax off $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/nosyntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
115 Also see |syntax-loading|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
116
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
117 NOTE: If displaying long lines is slow and switching off syntax highlighting
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
118 makes it fast, consider setting the 'synmaxcol' option to a lower value.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
119
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
120 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
121 2. Syntax files *:syn-files*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
122
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
123 The syntax and highlighting commands for one language are normally stored in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
124 a syntax file. The name convention is: "{name}.vim". Where {name} is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
125 name of the language, or an abbreviation (to fit the name in 8.3 characters,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
126 a requirement in case the file is used on a DOS filesystem).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
127 Examples:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
128 c.vim perl.vim java.vim html.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
129 cpp.vim sh.vim csh.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
131 The syntax file can contain any Ex commands, just like a vimrc file. But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
132 the idea is that only commands for a specific language are included. When a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
133 language is a superset of another language, it may include the other one,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
134 for example, the cpp.vim file could include the c.vim file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
135 :so $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
136
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
137 The .vim files are normally loaded with an autocommand. For example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
138 :au Syntax c runtime! syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
139 :au Syntax cpp runtime! syntax/cpp.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
140 These commands are normally in the file $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/synload.vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
141
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
142
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
143 MAKING YOUR OWN SYNTAX FILES *mysyntaxfile*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
144
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
145 When you create your own syntax files, and you want to have Vim use these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
146 automatically with ":syntax enable", do this:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
148 1. Create your user runtime directory. You would normally use the first item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
149 of the 'runtimepath' option. Example for Unix: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
150 mkdir ~/.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
151
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
152 2. Create a directory in there called "syntax". For Unix: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
153 mkdir ~/.vim/syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
155 3. Write the Vim syntax file. Or download one from the internet. Then write
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
156 it in your syntax directory. For example, for the "mine" syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
157 :w ~/.vim/syntax/mine.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
158
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
159 Now you can start using your syntax file manually: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
160 :set syntax=mine
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
161 You don't have to exit Vim to use this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
163 If you also want Vim to detect the type of file, see |new-filetype|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
164
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
165 If you are setting up a system with many users and you don't want each user
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
166 to add the same syntax file, you can use another directory from 'runtimepath'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
168
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
169 ADDING TO AN EXISTING SYNTAX FILE *mysyntaxfile-add*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
170
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
171 If you are mostly satisfied with an existing syntax file, but would like to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
172 add a few items or change the highlighting, follow these steps:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
173
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
174 1. Create your user directory from 'runtimepath', see above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
176 2. Create a directory in there called "after/syntax". For Unix: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
177 mkdir ~/.vim/after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
178 mkdir ~/.vim/after/syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
179
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
180 3. Write a Vim script that contains the commands you want to use. For
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
181 example, to change the colors for the C syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
182 highlight cComment ctermfg=Green guifg=Green
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
184 4. Write that file in the "after/syntax" directory. Use the name of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
185 syntax, with ".vim" added. For our C syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
186 :w ~/.vim/after/syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
188 That's it. The next time you edit a C file the Comment color will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
189 different. You don't even have to restart Vim.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
190
169
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
191 If you have multiple files, you can use the filetype as the directory name.
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
192 All the "*.vim" files in this directory will be used, for example:
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
193 ~/.vim/after/syntax/c/one.vim
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
194 ~/.vim/after/syntax/c/two.vim
0e902b8f511f updated for version 7.0051
vimboss
parents: 140
diff changeset
195
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
196
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
197 REPLACING AN EXISTING SYNTAX FILE *mysyntaxfile-replace*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
199 If you don't like a distributed syntax file, or you have downloaded a new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
200 version, follow the same steps as for |mysyntaxfile| above. Just make sure
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
201 that you write the syntax file in a directory that is early in 'runtimepath'.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
202 Vim will only load the first syntax file found, assuming that it sets
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
203 b:current_syntax.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
205
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
206 NAMING CONVENTIONS *group-name* *{group-name}* *E669* *W18*
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
207
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
208 A syntax group name is to be used for syntax items that match the same kind of
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
209 thing. These are then linked to a highlight group that specifies the color.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
210 A syntax group name doesn't specify any color or attributes itself.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
211
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
212 The name for a highlight or syntax group must consist of ASCII letters, digits
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
213 and the underscore. As a regexp: "[a-zA-Z0-9_]*"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
214
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
215 To be able to allow each user to pick his favorite set of colors, there must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
216 be preferred names for highlight groups that are common for many languages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
217 These are the suggested group names (if syntax highlighting works properly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
218 you can see the actual color, except for "Ignore"):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
219
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
220 *Comment any comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
221
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
222 *Constant any constant
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
223 String a string constant: "this is a string"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
224 Character a character constant: 'c', '\n'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
225 Number a number constant: 234, 0xff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
226 Boolean a boolean constant: TRUE, false
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
227 Float a floating point constant: 2.3e10
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
228
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
229 *Identifier any variable name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
230 Function function name (also: methods for classes)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
231
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
232 *Statement any statement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
233 Conditional if, then, else, endif, switch, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
234 Repeat for, do, while, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
235 Label case, default, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
236 Operator "sizeof", "+", "*", etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
237 Keyword any other keyword
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
238 Exception try, catch, throw
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
240 *PreProc generic Preprocessor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
241 Include preprocessor #include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
242 Define preprocessor #define
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
243 Macro same as Define
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
244 PreCondit preprocessor #if, #else, #endif, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
245
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
246 *Type int, long, char, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
247 StorageClass static, register, volatile, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
248 Structure struct, union, enum, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
249 Typedef A typedef
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
250
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
251 *Special any special symbol
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
252 SpecialChar special character in a constant
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
253 Tag you can use CTRL-] on this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
254 Delimiter character that needs attention
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
255 SpecialComment special things inside a comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
256 Debug debugging statements
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
257
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
258 *Underlined text that stands out, HTML links
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
259
2386
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
260 *Ignore left blank, hidden |hl-Ignore|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
261
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
262 *Error any erroneous construct
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
263
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
264 *Todo anything that needs extra attention; mostly the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
265 keywords TODO FIXME and XXX
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
266
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
267 The names marked with * are the preferred groups; the others are minor groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
268 For the preferred groups, the "syntax.vim" file contains default highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
269 The minor groups are linked to the preferred groups, so they get the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
270 highlighting. You can override these defaults by using ":highlight" commands
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
271 after sourcing the "syntax.vim" file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
272
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
273 Note that highlight group names are not case sensitive. "String" and "string"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
274 can be used for the same group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
275
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
276 The following names are reserved and cannot be used as a group name:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
277 NONE ALL ALLBUT contains contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
278
2386
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
279 *hl-Ignore*
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
280 When using the Ignore group, you may also consider using the conceal
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
281 mechanism. See |conceal|.
fb8cce4174f0 Better text for 'concealcursor' in :options window.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2378
diff changeset
282
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
283 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
284 3. Syntax loading procedure *syntax-loading*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
285
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
286 This explains the details that happen when the command ":syntax enable" is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
287 issued. When Vim initializes itself, it finds out where the runtime files are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
288 located. This is used here as the variable |$VIMRUNTIME|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
289
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
290 ":syntax enable" and ":syntax on" do the following:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
291
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
292 Source $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
293 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
294 +- Clear out any old syntax by sourcing $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/nosyntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
295 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
296 +- Source first syntax/synload.vim in 'runtimepath'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
297 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
298 | +- Setup the colors for syntax highlighting. If a color scheme is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
299 | | defined it is loaded again with ":colors {name}". Otherwise
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
300 | | ":runtime! syntax/syncolor.vim" is used. ":syntax on" overrules
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
301 | | existing colors, ":syntax enable" only sets groups that weren't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
302 | | set yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
303 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
304 | +- Set up syntax autocmds to load the appropriate syntax file when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
305 | | the 'syntax' option is set. *synload-1*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
306 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
307 | +- Source the user's optional file, from the |mysyntaxfile| variable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
308 | This is for backwards compatibility with Vim 5.x only. *synload-2*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
309 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
310 +- Do ":filetype on", which does ":runtime! filetype.vim". It loads any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
311 | filetype.vim files found. It should always Source
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
312 | $VIMRUNTIME/filetype.vim, which does the following.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
313 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
314 | +- Install autocmds based on suffix to set the 'filetype' option
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
315 | | This is where the connection between file name and file type is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
316 | | made for known file types. *synload-3*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
317 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
318 | +- Source the user's optional file, from the *myfiletypefile*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
319 | | variable. This is for backwards compatibility with Vim 5.x only.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
320 | | *synload-4*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
321 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
322 | +- Install one autocommand which sources scripts.vim when no file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
323 | | type was detected yet. *synload-5*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
324 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
325 | +- Source $VIMRUNTIME/menu.vim, to setup the Syntax menu. |menu.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
326 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
327 +- Install a FileType autocommand to set the 'syntax' option when a file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
328 | type has been detected. *synload-6*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
329 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
330 +- Execute syntax autocommands to start syntax highlighting for each
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
331 already loaded buffer.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
333
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
334 Upon loading a file, Vim finds the relevant syntax file as follows:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
336 Loading the file triggers the BufReadPost autocommands.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
337 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
338 +- If there is a match with one of the autocommands from |synload-3|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
339 | (known file types) or |synload-4| (user's file types), the 'filetype'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
340 | option is set to the file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
341 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
342 +- The autocommand at |synload-5| is triggered. If the file type was not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
343 | found yet, then scripts.vim is searched for in 'runtimepath'. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
344 | should always load $VIMRUNTIME/scripts.vim, which does the following.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
345 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
346 | +- Source the user's optional file, from the *myscriptsfile*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
347 | | variable. This is for backwards compatibility with Vim 5.x only.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
348 | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
349 | +- If the file type is still unknown, check the contents of the file,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
350 | again with checks like "getline(1) =~ pattern" as to whether the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
351 | file type can be recognized, and set 'filetype'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
352 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
353 +- When the file type was determined and 'filetype' was set, this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
354 | triggers the FileType autocommand |synload-6| above. It sets
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
355 | 'syntax' to the determined file type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
356 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
357 +- When the 'syntax' option was set above, this triggers an autocommand
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
358 | from |synload-1| (and |synload-2|). This find the main syntax file in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
359 | 'runtimepath', with this command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
360 | runtime! syntax/<name>.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
361 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
362 +- Any other user installed FileType or Syntax autocommands are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
363 triggered. This can be used to change the highlighting for a specific
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
364 syntax.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
365
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
366 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
367 4. Syntax file remarks *:syn-file-remarks*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
369 *b:current_syntax-variable*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
370 Vim stores the name of the syntax that has been loaded in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
371 "b:current_syntax" variable. You can use this if you want to load other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
372 settings, depending on which syntax is active. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
373 :au BufReadPost * if b:current_syntax == "csh"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
374 :au BufReadPost * do-some-things
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
375 :au BufReadPost * endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
376
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
377
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
378 2HTML *2html.vim* *convert-to-HTML*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
379
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
380 This is not a syntax file itself, but a script that converts the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
381 window into HTML. Vim opens a new window in which it builds the HTML file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
382
3713
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
383 After you save the resulting file, you can view it with any browser. The
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
384 colors should be exactly the same as you see them in Vim.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
385
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
386 You are not supposed to set the 'filetype' or 'syntax' option to "2html"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
387 Source the script to convert the current file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
388
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
389 :runtime! syntax/2html.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
390 <
3713
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
391 Many variables affect the output of 2html.vim; see below. Any of the on/off
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
392 options listed below can be enabled or disabled by setting them explicitly to
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
393 the desired value, or restored to their default by removing the variable using
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
394 |:unlet|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
395
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
396 Remarks:
2496
a29075150aee Improve handling of user settings in :TOhtml. Default to generating CSS.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2494
diff changeset
397 - Some truly ancient browsers may not show the background colors.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
398 - From most browsers you can also print the file (in color)!
3713
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
399 - The latest TOhtml may actually work with older versions of Vim, but some
2642
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
400 features such as conceal support will not function, and the colors may be
840c3cadb842 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2596
diff changeset
401 incorrect for an old Vim without GUI support compiled in.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
402
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
403 Here is an example how to run the script over all .c and .h files from a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
404 Unix shell: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
405 for f in *.[ch]; do gvim -f +"syn on" +"run! syntax/2html.vim" +"wq" +"q" $f; done
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
406 <
3713
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
407 *g:html_start_line* *g:html_end_line*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
408 To restrict the conversion to a range of lines, use a range with the |:TOhtml|
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
409 command below, or set "g:html_start_line" and "g:html_end_line" to the first
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
410 and last line to be converted. Example, using the last set Visual area: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
411
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
412 :let g:html_start_line = line("'<")
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
413 :let g:html_end_line = line("'>")
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
414 :runtime! syntax/2html.vim
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
415 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
416 *:TOhtml*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
417 :[range]TOhtml The ":TOhtml" command is defined in a standard plugin.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
418 This command will source |2html.vim| for you. When a
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
419 range is given, set |g:html_start_line| and
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
420 |g:html_end_line| to the start and end of the range,
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
421 respectively. Default range is the entire buffer.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
422
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
423 If the current window is part of a |diff|, unless
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
424 |g:html_diff_one_file| is set, :TOhtml will convert
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
425 all windows which are part of the diff in the current
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
426 tab and place them side-by-side in a <table> element
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
427 in the generated HTML.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
428
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
429 Examples: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
430
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
431 :10,40TOhtml " convert lines 10-40 to html
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
432 :'<,'>TOhtml " convert current/last visual selection
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
433 :TOhtml " convert entire buffer
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
434 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
435 *g:html_diff_one_file*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
436 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
437 When 0, all windows involved in a |diff| in the current tab page are converted
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
438 to HTML and placed side-by-side in a <table> element.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
439 When 1, only the current buffer is converted.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
440 Example: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
441
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
442 let g:html_diff_one_file = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
443 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
444 *g:html_whole_filler*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
445 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
446 When 0, if |g:html_diff_one_file| is 1, a sequence of more than 3 filler lines
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
447 is displayed as three lines with the middle line mentioning the total number
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
448 of inserted lines.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
449 When 1, always display all inserted lines as if |g:html_diff_one_file| were
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
450 not set.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
451 >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
452 :let g:html_whole_filler = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
453 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
454 *TOhtml-performance* *g:html_no_progress*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
455 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
456 When 0, display a progress bar in the statusline for each major step in the
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
457 2html.vim conversion process.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
458 When 1, do not display the progress bar. This offers a minor speed improvement
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
459 but you won't have any idea how much longer the conversion might take; for big
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
460 files it can take a long time!
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
461 Example: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
462
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
463 let g:html_no_progress = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
464 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
465 You can obtain better performance improvements by also instructing Vim to not
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
466 run interactively, so that too much time is not taken to redraw as the script
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
467 moves through the buffer, switches windows, and the like: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
468
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
469 vim -E -s -c "let g:html_no_progress=1" -c "syntax on" -c "set ft=c" -c "runtime syntax/2html.vim" -cwqa myfile.c
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
470 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
471 Note that the -s flag prevents loading your .vimrc and any plugins, so you
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
472 need to explicitly source/enable anything that will affect the HTML
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
473 conversion. See |-E| and |-s-ex| for details. It is probably best to create a
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
474 script to replace all the -c commands and use it with the -u flag instead of
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
475 specifying each command separately.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
476
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
477 *g:html_number_lines*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
478 Default: current 'number' setting.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
479 When 0, buffer text is displayed in the generated HTML without line numbering.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
480 When 1, a column of line numbers is added to the generated HTML with the same
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
481 highlighting as the line number column in Vim (|hl-LineNr|).
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
482 Force line numbers even if 'number' is not set: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
483 :let g:html_number_lines = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
484 Force to omit the line numbers: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
485 :let g:html_number_lines = 0
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
486 Go back to the default to use 'number' by deleting the variable: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
487 :unlet g:html_number_lines
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
488 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
489 *g:html_use_css*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
490 Default: 1.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
491 When 1, generate valid HTML 4.01 markup with CSS1 styling, supported in all
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
492 modern browsers and most old browsers.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
493 When 0, generate <font> tags and similar outdated markup. This is not
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
494 recommended but it may work better in really old browsers, email clients,
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
495 forum posts, and similar situations where basic CSS support is unavailable.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
496 Example: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
497 :let g:html_use_css = 0
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
498 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
499 *g:html_ignore_conceal*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
500 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
501 When 0, concealed text is removed from the HTML and replaced with a character
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
502 from |:syn-cchar| or 'listchars' as appropriate, depending on the current
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
503 value of 'conceallevel'.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
504 When 1, include all text from the buffer in the generated HTML, even if it is
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
505 |conceal|ed.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
506
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
507 Either of the following commands will ensure that all text in the buffer is
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
508 included in the generated HTML (unless it is folded): >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
509 :let g:html_ignore_conceal = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
510 :setl conceallevel=0
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
511 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
512 *g:html_ignore_folding*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
513 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
514 When 0, text in a closed fold is replaced by the text shown for the fold in
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
515 Vim (|fold-foldtext|). See |g:html_dynamic_folds| if you also want to allow
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
516 the user to expand the fold as in Vim to see the text inside.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
517 When 1, include all text from the buffer in the generated HTML; whether the
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
518 text is in a fold has no impact at all. |g:html_dynamic_folds| has no effect.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
519
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
520 Either of these commands will ensure that all text in the buffer is included
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
521 in the generated HTML (unless it is concealed): >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
522 zR
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
523 :let g:html_ignore_folding = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
524 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
525 *g:html_dynamic_folds*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
526 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
527 When 0, text in a closed fold is not included at all in the generated HTML.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
528 When 1, generate javascript to open a fold and show the text within, just like
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
529 in Vim.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
530
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
531 Setting this variable to 1 causes 2html.vim to always use CSS for styling,
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
532 regardless of what |g:html_use_css| is set to.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
533
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
534 This variable is ignored when |g:html_ignore_folding| is set.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
535 >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
536 :let g:html_dynamic_folds = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
537 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
538 *g:html_no_foldcolumn*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
539 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
540 When 0, if |g:html_dynamic_folds| is 1, generate a column of text similar to
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
541 Vim's foldcolumn (|fold-foldcolumn|) the user can click on to toggle folds
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
542 open or closed. The minimum width of the generated text column is the current
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
543 'foldcolumn' setting.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
544 When 1, do not generate this column; instead, hovering the mouse cursor over
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
545 folded text will open the fold as if |g:html_hover_unfold| were set.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
546 >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
547 :let g:html_no_foldcolumn = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
548 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
549 *TOhtml-uncopyable-text* *g:html_prevent_copy*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
550 Default: empty string.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
551 This option prevents certain regions of the generated HTML from being copied,
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
552 when you select all text in document rendered in a browser and copy it. Useful
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
553 for allowing users to copy-paste only the source text even if a fold column or
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
554 line numbers are shown in the generated content. Specify regions to be
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
555 affected in this way as follows:
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
556 f: fold column
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
557 n: line numbers (also within fold text)
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
558 t: fold text
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
559 d: diff filler
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
560
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
561 Example, to make the fold column and line numbers uncopyable: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
562 :let g:html_prevent_copy = "fn"
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
563 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
564 This feature is currently implemented by inserting read-only <input> elements
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
565 into the markup to contain the uncopyable areas. This does not work well in
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
566 all cases. When pasting to some applications which understand HTML, the
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
567 <input> elements also get pasted. But plain-text paste destinations should
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
568 always work.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
569
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
570 *g:html_no_invalid*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
571 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
572 When 0, if |g:html_prevent_copy| is non-empty, an invalid attribute is
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
573 intentionally inserted into the <input> element for the uncopyable areas. This
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
574 increases the number of applications you can paste to without also pasting the
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
575 <input> elements. Specifically, Microsoft Word will not paste the <input>
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
576 elements if they contain this invalid attribute.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
577 When 1, no invalid markup is ever intentionally inserted, and the generated
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
578 page should validate. However, be careful pasting into Microsoft Word when
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
579 |g:html_prevent_copy| is non-empty; it can be hard to get rid of the <input>
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
580 elements which get pasted.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
581
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
582 *g:html_hover_unfold*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
583 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
584 When 0, the only way to open a fold generated by 2html.vim with
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
585 |g:html_dynamic_folds| set, is to click on the generated fold column.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
586 When 1, use CSS 2.0 to allow the user to open a fold by moving the mouse
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
587 cursor over the displayed fold text. This is useful to allow users with
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
588 disabled javascript to view the folded text.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
589
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
590 Note that old browsers (notably Internet Explorer 6) will not support this
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
591 feature. Browser-specific markup for IE6 is included to fall back to the
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
592 normal CSS1 styling so that the folds show up correctly for this browser, but
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
593 they will not be openable without a foldcolumn.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
594 >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
595 :let g:html_hover_unfold = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
596 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
597 *TOhtml-wrap-text* *g:html_pre_wrap*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
598 Default: current 'wrap' setting.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
599 When 0, if |g:html_no_pre| is 0 or unset, the text in the generated HTML does
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
600 not wrap at the edge of the browser window.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
601 When 1, if |g:html_use_css| is 1, the CSS 2.0 "white-space:pre-wrap" value is
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
602 used, causing the text to wrap at whitespace at the edge of the browser
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
603 window.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
604 Explicitly enable text wrapping: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
605 :let g:html_pre_wrap = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
606 Explicitly disable wrapping: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
607 :let g:html_pre_wrap = 0
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
608 Go back to default, determine wrapping from 'wrap' setting: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
609 :unlet g:html_pre_wrap
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
610 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
611 *g:html_no_pre*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
612 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
613 When 0, buffer text in the generated HTML is surrounded by <pre>...</pre>
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
614 tags. Series of whitespace is shown as in Vim without special markup, and tab
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
615 characters can be included literally (see |g:html_expand_tabs|).
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
616 When 1 (not recommended), the <pre> tags are omitted, and a plain <div> is
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
617 used instead. Whitespace is replaced by a series of &nbsp; character
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
618 references, and <br> is used to end each line. This is another way to allow
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
619 text in the generated HTML is wrap (see |g:html_pre_wrap|) which also works in
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
620 old browsers, but may cause noticeable differences between Vim's display and
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
621 the rendered page generated by 2html.vim.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
622 >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
623 :let g:html_no_pre = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
624 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
625 *g:html_expand_tabs*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
626 Default: 1 if 'tabstop' is 8, 'expandtab' is 0, and no fold column or line
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
627 numbers occur in the generated HTML;
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
628 0 otherwise.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
629 When 0, <Tab> characters in the buffer text are replaced with an appropriate
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
630 number of space characters, or &nbsp; references if |g:html_no_pre| is 1.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
631 When 1, if |g:html_no_pre| is 0 or unset, <Tab> characters in the buffer text
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
632 are included as-is in the generated HTML. This is useful for when you want to
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
633 allow copy and paste from a browser without losing the actual whitespace in
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
634 the source document. Note that this can easily break text alignment and
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
635 indentation in the HTML, unless set by default.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
636
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
637 Force |2html.vim| to keep <Tab> characters: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
638 :let g:html_expand_tabs = 0
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
639 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
640 Force tabs to be expanded: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
641 :let g:html_expand_tabs = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
642 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
643 *TOhtml-encoding-detect* *TOhtml-encoding*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
644 It is highly recommended to set your desired encoding with
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
645 |g:html_use_encoding| for any content which will be placed on a web server.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
646
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
647 If you do not specify an encoding, |2html.vim| uses the preferred IANA name
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
648 for the current value of 'fileencoding' if set, or 'encoding' if not.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
649 'encoding' is always used for certain 'buftype' values. 'fileencoding' will be
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
650 set to match the chosen document encoding.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
651
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
652 Automatic detection works for the encodings mentioned specifically by name in
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
653 |encoding-names|, but TOhtml will only automatically use those encodings with
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
654 wide browser support. However, you can override this to support specific
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
655 encodings that may not be automatically detected by default (see options
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
656 below). See http://www.iana.org/assignments/character-sets for the IANA names.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
657
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
658 Note, by default all Unicode encodings are converted to UTF-8 with no BOM in
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
659 the generated HTML, as recommended by W3C:
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
660
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
661 http://www.w3.org/International/questions/qa-choosing-encodings
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
662 http://www.w3.org/International/questions/qa-byte-order-mark
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
663
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
664 *g:html_use_encoding*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
665 Default: none, uses IANA name for current 'fileencoding' as above.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
666 To overrule all automatic charset detection, set g:html_use_encoding to the
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
667 name of the charset to be used. It is recommended to set this variable to
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
668 something widely supported, like UTF-8, for anything you will be hosting on a
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
669 webserver: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
670 :let g:html_use_encoding = "UTF-8"
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
671 You can also use this option to omit the line that specifies the charset
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
672 entirely, by setting g:html_use_encoding to an empty string (NOT recommended): >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
673 :let g:html_use_encoding = ""
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
674 To go back to the automatic mechanism, delete the |g:html_use_encoding|
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
675 variable: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
676 :unlet g:html_use_encoding
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
677 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
678 *g:html_encoding_override*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
679 Default: none, autoload/tohtml.vim contains default conversions for encodings
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
680 mentioned by name at |encoding-names|.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
681 This option allows |2html.vim| to detect the correct 'fileencoding' when you
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
682 specify an encoding with |g:html_use_encoding| which is not in the default
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
683 list of conversions.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
684
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
685 This is a dictionary of charset-encoding pairs that will replace existing
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
686 pairs automatically detected by TOhtml, or supplement with new pairs.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
687
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
688 Detect the HTML charset "windows-1252" as the encoding "8bit-cp1252": >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
689 :let g:html_encoding_override = {'windows-1252': '8bit-cp1252'}
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
690 <
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
691 *g:html_charset_override*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
692 Default: none, autoload/tohtml.vim contains default conversions for encodings
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
693 mentioned by name at |encoding-names| and which have wide
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
694 browser support.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
695 This option allows |2html.vim| to detect the HTML charset for any
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
696 'fileencoding' or 'encoding' which is not detected automatically. You can also
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
697 use it to override specific existing encoding-charset pairs. For example,
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
698 TOhtml will by default use UTF-8 for all Unicode/UCS encodings. To use UTF-16
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
699 and UTF-32 instead, use: >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
700 :let g:html_charset_override = {'ucs-4': 'UTF-32', 'utf-16': 'UTF-16'}
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
701
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
702 Note that documents encoded in either UTF-32 or UTF-16 have known
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
703 compatibility problems with some major browsers.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
704
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
705 *convert-to-XML* *convert-to-XHTML* *g:html_use_xhtml*
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
706 Default: 0.
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
707 When 0, generate standard HTML 4.01 (strict when possible).
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
708 When 1, generate XHTML 1.0 instead (XML compliant HTML).
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
709 >
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
710 :let g:html_use_xhtml = 1
9910cbff5f16 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3682
diff changeset
711 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
712
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
713 ABEL *abel.vim* *ft-abel-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
714
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
715 ABEL highlighting provides some user-defined options. To enable them, assign
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
716 any value to the respective variable. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
717 :let abel_obsolete_ok=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
718 To disable them use ":unlet". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
719 :unlet abel_obsolete_ok
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
720
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
721 Variable Highlight ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
722 abel_obsolete_ok obsolete keywords are statements, not errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
723 abel_cpp_comments_illegal do not interpret '//' as inline comment leader
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
724
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
725
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
726 ADA
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
727
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
728 See |ft-ada-syntax|
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
729
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
730
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
731 ANT *ant.vim* *ft-ant-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
732
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
733 The ant syntax file provides syntax highlighting for javascript and python
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
734 by default. Syntax highlighting for other script languages can be installed
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
735 by the function AntSyntaxScript(), which takes the tag name as first argument
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
736 and the script syntax file name as second argument. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
737
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
738 :call AntSyntaxScript('perl', 'perl.vim')
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
739
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
740 will install syntax perl highlighting for the following ant code >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
742 <script language = 'perl'><![CDATA[
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
743 # everything inside is highlighted as perl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
744 ]]></script>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
745
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
746 See |mysyntaxfile-add| for installing script languages permanently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
747
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
748
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
749 APACHE *apache.vim* *ft-apache-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
750
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
751 The apache syntax file provides syntax highlighting depending on Apache HTTP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
752 server version, by default for 1.3.x. Set "apache_version" to Apache version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
753 (as a string) to get highlighting for another version. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
754
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
755 :let apache_version = "2.0"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
756 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
757
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
758 *asm.vim* *asmh8300.vim* *nasm.vim* *masm.vim* *asm68k*
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
759 ASSEMBLY *ft-asm-syntax* *ft-asmh8300-syntax* *ft-nasm-syntax*
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
760 *ft-masm-syntax* *ft-asm68k-syntax* *fasm.vim*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
761
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
762 Files matching "*.i" could be Progress or Assembly. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
763 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit Progress at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
764 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
765 :let filetype_i = "asm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
766 Replace "asm" with the type of assembly you use.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
767
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
768 There are many types of assembly languages that all use the same file name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
769 extensions. Therefore you will have to select the type yourself, or add a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
770 line in the assembly file that Vim will recognize. Currently these syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
771 files are included:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
772 asm GNU assembly (the default)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
773 asm68k Motorola 680x0 assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
774 asmh8300 Hitachi H-8300 version of GNU assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
775 ia64 Intel Itanium 64
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
776 fasm Flat assembly (http://flatassembler.net)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
777 masm Microsoft assembly (probably works for any 80x86)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
778 nasm Netwide assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
779 tasm Turbo Assembly (with opcodes 80x86 up to Pentium, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
780 MMX)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
781 pic PIC assembly (currently for PIC16F84)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
782
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
783 The most flexible is to add a line in your assembly file containing: >
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
784 asmsyntax=nasm
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
785 Replace "nasm" with the name of the real assembly syntax. This line must be
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
786 one of the first five lines in the file. No non-white text must be
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3492
diff changeset
787 immediately before or after this text. Note that specifying asmsyntax=foo is
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3492
diff changeset
788 equivalent to setting ft=foo in a |modeline|, and that in case of a conflict
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3492
diff changeset
789 between the two settings the one from the modeline will take precedence (in
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3492
diff changeset
790 particular, if you have ft=asm in the modeline, you will get the GNU syntax
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3492
diff changeset
791 highlighting regardless of what is specified as asmsyntax).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
792
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
793 The syntax type can always be overruled for a specific buffer by setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
794 b:asmsyntax variable: >
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
795 :let b:asmsyntax = "nasm"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
796
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
797 If b:asmsyntax is not set, either automatically or by hand, then the value of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
798 the global variable asmsyntax is used. This can be seen as a default assembly
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
799 language: >
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
800 :let asmsyntax = "nasm"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
801
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
802 As a last resort, if nothing is defined, the "asm" syntax is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
803
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
804
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
805 Netwide assembler (nasm.vim) optional highlighting ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
806
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
807 To enable a feature: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
808 :let {variable}=1|set syntax=nasm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
809 To disable a feature: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
810 :unlet {variable} |set syntax=nasm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
811
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
812 Variable Highlight ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
813 nasm_loose_syntax unofficial parser allowed syntax not as Error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
814 (parser dependent; not recommended)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
815 nasm_ctx_outside_macro contexts outside macro not as Error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
816 nasm_no_warn potentially risky syntax not as ToDo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
817
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
818
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
819 ASPPERL and ASPVBS *ft-aspperl-syntax* *ft-aspvbs-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
820
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
821 *.asp and *.asa files could be either Perl or Visual Basic script. Since it's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
822 hard to detect this you can set two global variables to tell Vim what you are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
823 using. For Perl script use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
824 :let g:filetype_asa = "aspperl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
825 :let g:filetype_asp = "aspperl"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
826 For Visual Basic use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
827 :let g:filetype_asa = "aspvbs"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
828 :let g:filetype_asp = "aspvbs"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
829
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
830
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
831 BAAN *baan.vim* *baan-syntax*
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
832
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
833 The baan.vim gives syntax support for BaanC of release BaanIV upto SSA ERP LN
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
834 for both 3 GL and 4 GL programming. Large number of standard defines/constants
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
835 are supported.
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
836
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
837 Some special violation of coding standards will be signalled when one specify
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
838 in ones |.vimrc|: >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
839 let baan_code_stds=1
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
840
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
841 *baan-folding*
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
842
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
843 Syntax folding can be enabled at various levels through the variables
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
844 mentioned below (Set those in your |.vimrc|). The more complex folding on
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
845 source blocks and SQL can be CPU intensive.
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
846
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
847 To allow any folding and enable folding at function level use: >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
848 let baan_fold=1
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
849 Folding can be enabled at source block level as if, while, for ,... The
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
850 indentation preceding the begin/end keywords has to match (spaces are not
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
851 considered equal to a tab). >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
852 let baan_fold_block=1
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
853 Folding can be enabled for embedded SQL blocks as SELECT, SELECTDO,
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
854 SELECTEMPTY, ... The indentation preceding the begin/end keywords has to
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
855 match (spaces are not considered equal to a tab). >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
856 let baan_fold_sql=1
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
857 Note: Block folding can result in many small folds. It is suggested to |:set|
844
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
858 the options 'foldminlines' and 'foldnestmax' in |.vimrc| or use |:setlocal| in
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
859 .../after/syntax/baan.vim (see |after-directory|). Eg: >
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
860 set foldminlines=5
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
861 set foldnestmax=6
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
862
d3bbb5dd3913 updated for version 7.0f02
vimboss
parents: 842
diff changeset
863
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
864 BASIC *basic.vim* *vb.vim* *ft-basic-syntax* *ft-vb-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
865
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
866 Both Visual Basic and "normal" basic use the extension ".bas". To detect
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
867 which one should be used, Vim checks for the string "VB_Name" in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
868 five lines of the file. If it is not found, filetype will be "basic",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
869 otherwise "vb". Files with the ".frm" extension will always be seen as Visual
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
870 Basic.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
871
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
872
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
873 C *c.vim* *ft-c-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
874
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
875 A few things in C highlighting are optional. To enable them assign any value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
876 to the respective variable. Example: >
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
877 :let c_comment_strings = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
878 To disable them use ":unlet". Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
879 :unlet c_comment_strings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
880
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
881 Variable Highlight ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
882 c_gnu GNU gcc specific items
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
883 c_comment_strings strings and numbers inside a comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
884 c_space_errors trailing white space and spaces before a <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
885 c_no_trail_space_error ... but no trailing spaces
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
886 c_no_tab_space_error ... but no spaces before a <Tab>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
887 c_no_bracket_error don't highlight {}; inside [] as errors
140
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
888 c_no_curly_error don't highlight {}; inside [] and () as errors;
8ecb0db93e9a updated for version 7.0045
vimboss
parents: 36
diff changeset
889 except { and } in first column
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
890 c_curly_error highlight a missing }; this forces syncing from the
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
891 start of the file, can be slow
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
892 c_no_ansi don't do standard ANSI types and constants
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
893 c_ansi_typedefs ... but do standard ANSI types
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
894 c_ansi_constants ... but do standard ANSI constants
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
895 c_no_utf don't highlight \u and \U in strings
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
896 c_syntax_for_h for *.h files use C syntax instead of C++ and use objc
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
897 syntax instead of objcpp
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
898 c_no_if0 don't highlight "#if 0" blocks as comments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
899 c_no_cformat don't highlight %-formats in strings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
900 c_no_c99 don't highlight C99 standard items
3256
ba708ee8d69d Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
901 c_no_c11 don't highlight C11 standard items
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
902
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
903 When 'foldmethod' is set to "syntax" then /* */ comments and { } blocks will
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
904 become a fold. If you don't want comments to become a fold use: >
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
905 :let c_no_comment_fold = 1
842
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
906 "#if 0" blocks are also folded, unless: >
a209672376fd updated for version 7.0f
vimboss
parents: 838
diff changeset
907 :let c_no_if0_fold = 1
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
908
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
909 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
910 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "c_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
911 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
912 :let c_minlines = 100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
913 This will make the syntax synchronization start 100 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
914 displayed line. The default value is 50 (15 when c_no_if0 is set). The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
915 disadvantage of using a larger number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
916
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
917 When using the "#if 0" / "#endif" comment highlighting, notice that this only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
918 works when the "#if 0" is within "c_minlines" from the top of the window. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
919 you have a long "#if 0" construct it will not be highlighted correctly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
920
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
921 To match extra items in comments, use the cCommentGroup cluster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
922 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
923 :au Syntax c call MyCadd()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
924 :function MyCadd()
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
925 : syn keyword cMyItem contained Ni
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
926 : syn cluster cCommentGroup add=cMyItem
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
927 : hi link cMyItem Title
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
928 :endfun
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
929
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
930 ANSI constants will be highlighted with the "cConstant" group. This includes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
931 "NULL", "SIG_IGN" and others. But not "TRUE", for example, because this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
932 not in the ANSI standard. If you find this confusing, remove the cConstant
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
933 highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
934 :hi link cConstant NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
935
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
936 If you see '{' and '}' highlighted as an error where they are OK, reset the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
937 highlighting for cErrInParen and cErrInBracket.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
938
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
939 If you want to use folding in your C files, you can add these lines in a file
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
940 in the "after" directory in 'runtimepath'. For Unix this would be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
941 ~/.vim/after/syntax/c.vim. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
942 syn sync fromstart
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
943 set foldmethod=syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
944
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
945 CH *ch.vim* *ft-ch-syntax*
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
946
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
947 C/C++ interpreter. Ch has similar syntax highlighting to C and builds upon
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
948 the C syntax file. See |c.vim| for all the settings that are available for C.
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
949
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
950 By setting a variable you can tell Vim to use Ch syntax for *.h files, instead
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
951 of C or C++: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
952 :let ch_syntax_for_h = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
953
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
954
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
955 CHILL *chill.vim* *ft-chill-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
956
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
957 Chill syntax highlighting is similar to C. See |c.vim| for all the settings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
958 that are available. Additionally there is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
959
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
960 chill_space_errors like c_space_errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
961 chill_comment_string like c_comment_strings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
962 chill_minlines like c_minlines
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
963
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
964
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
965 CHANGELOG *changelog.vim* *ft-changelog-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
966
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
967 ChangeLog supports highlighting spaces at the start of a line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
968 If you do not like this, add following line to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
969 let g:changelog_spacing_errors = 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
970 This works the next time you edit a changelog file. You can also use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
971 "b:changelog_spacing_errors" to set this per buffer (before loading the syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
972 file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
973
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
974 You can change the highlighting used, e.g., to flag the spaces as an error: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
975 :hi link ChangelogError Error
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
976 Or to avoid the highlighting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
977 :hi link ChangelogError NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
978 This works immediately.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
979
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
980
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
981 COBOL *cobol.vim* *ft-cobol-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
982
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
983 COBOL highlighting has different needs for legacy code than it does for fresh
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
984 development. This is due to differences in what is being done (maintenance
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
985 versus development) and other factors. To enable legacy code highlighting,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
986 add this line to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
987 :let cobol_legacy_code = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
988 To disable it again, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
989 :unlet cobol_legacy_code
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
990
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
991
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
992 COLD FUSION *coldfusion.vim* *ft-coldfusion-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
993
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
994 The ColdFusion has its own version of HTML comments. To turn on ColdFusion
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
995 comment highlighting, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
996
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
997 :let html_wrong_comments = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
998
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
999 The ColdFusion syntax file is based on the HTML syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1001
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1002 CSH *csh.vim* *ft-csh-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1003
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1004 This covers the shell named "csh". Note that on some systems tcsh is actually
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1005 used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1006
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1007 Detecting whether a file is csh or tcsh is notoriously hard. Some systems
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1008 symlink /bin/csh to /bin/tcsh, making it almost impossible to distinguish
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1009 between csh and tcsh. In case VIM guesses wrong you can set the
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
1010 "filetype_csh" variable. For using csh: *g:filetype_csh*
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
1011 >
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
1012 :let g:filetype_csh = "csh"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1013
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1014 For using tcsh: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1015
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
1016 :let g:filetype_csh = "tcsh"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1017
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1018 Any script with a tcsh extension or a standard tcsh filename (.tcshrc,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1019 tcsh.tcshrc, tcsh.login) will have filetype tcsh. All other tcsh/csh scripts
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1020 will be classified as tcsh, UNLESS the "filetype_csh" variable exists. If the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1021 "filetype_csh" variable exists, the filetype will be set to the value of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1022 variable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1023
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1024
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1025 CYNLIB *cynlib.vim* *ft-cynlib-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1026
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1027 Cynlib files are C++ files that use the Cynlib class library to enable
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1028 hardware modelling and simulation using C++. Typically Cynlib files have a .cc
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1029 or a .cpp extension, which makes it very difficult to distinguish them from a
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1030 normal C++ file. Thus, to enable Cynlib highlighting for .cc files, add this
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1031 line to your .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1032
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1033 :let cynlib_cyntax_for_cc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1034
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1035 Similarly for cpp files (this extension is only usually used in Windows) >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1037 :let cynlib_cyntax_for_cpp=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1038
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1039 To disable these again, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1040
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1041 :unlet cynlib_cyntax_for_cc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1042 :unlet cynlib_cyntax_for_cpp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1043 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1044
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1045 CWEB *cweb.vim* *ft-cweb-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1046
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1047 Files matching "*.w" could be Progress or cweb. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1048 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit Progress at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1049 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1050 :let filetype_w = "cweb"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1051
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1052
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1053 DESKTOP *desktop.vim* *ft-desktop-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1054
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1055 Primary goal of this syntax file is to highlight .desktop and .directory files
2236
dc2e5ec0500d Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
1056 according to freedesktop.org standard:
dc2e5ec0500d Added the undofile() function. Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2207
diff changeset
1057 http://standards.freedesktop.org/desktop-entry-spec/latest/
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1058 But actually almost none implements this standard fully. Thus it will
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1059 highlight all Unix ini files. But you can force strict highlighting according
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1060 to standard by placing this in your vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1061 :let enforce_freedesktop_standard = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1062
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1063
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1064 DIRCOLORS *dircolors.vim* *ft-dircolors-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1065
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1066 The dircolors utility highlighting definition has one option. It exists to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1067 provide compatibility with the Slackware GNU/Linux distributions version of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1068 the command. It adds a few keywords that are generally ignored by most
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1069 versions. On Slackware systems, however, the utility accepts the keywords and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1070 uses them for processing. To enable the Slackware keywords add the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1071 line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1072 let dircolors_is_slackware = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1073
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1074
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1075 DOCBOOK *docbk.vim* *ft-docbk-syntax* *docbook*
2662
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
1076 DOCBOOK XML *docbkxml.vim* *ft-docbkxml-syntax*
916c90b37ea9 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2642
diff changeset
1077 DOCBOOK SGML *docbksgml.vim* *ft-docbksgml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1078
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1079 There are two types of DocBook files: SGML and XML. To specify what type you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1080 are using the "b:docbk_type" variable should be set. Vim does this for you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1081 automatically if it can recognize the type. When Vim can't guess it the type
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1082 defaults to XML.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1083 You can set the type manually: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1084 :let docbk_type = "sgml"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1085 or: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1086 :let docbk_type = "xml"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1087 You need to do this before loading the syntax file, which is complicated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1088 Simpler is setting the filetype to "docbkxml" or "docbksgml": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1089 :set filetype=docbksgml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1090 or: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1091 :set filetype=docbkxml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1092
3967
fdb8a9c7bd91 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
1093 You can specify the DocBook version: >
fdb8a9c7bd91 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
1094 :let docbk_ver = 3
fdb8a9c7bd91 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
1095 When not set 4 is used.
fdb8a9c7bd91 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3920
diff changeset
1096
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1097
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1098 DOSBATCH *dosbatch.vim* *ft-dosbatch-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1099
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1100 There is one option with highlighting DOS batch files. This covers new
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1101 extensions to the Command Interpreter introduced with Windows 2000 and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1102 is controlled by the variable dosbatch_cmdextversion. For Windows NT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1103 this should have the value 1, and for Windows 2000 it should be 2.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1104 Select the version you want with the following line: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1105
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1106 :let dosbatch_cmdextversion = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1107
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1108 If this variable is not defined it defaults to a value of 2 to support
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1109 Windows 2000.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1110
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1111 A second option covers whether *.btm files should be detected as type
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1112 "dosbatch" (MS-DOS batch files) or type "btm" (4DOS batch files). The latter
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1113 is used by default. You may select the former with the following line: >
15
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1114
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1115 :let g:dosbatch_syntax_for_btm = 1
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1116
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1117 If this variable is undefined or zero, btm syntax is selected.
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1118
631143ac4a01 updated for version 7.0007
vimboss
parents: 12
diff changeset
1119
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1120 DOXYGEN *doxygen.vim* *doxygen-syntax*
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1121
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1122 Doxygen generates code documentation using a special documentation format
1698
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
1123 (similar to Javadoc). This syntax script adds doxygen highlighting to c, cpp,
f4f8014d516e updated for version 7.2c-000
vimboss
parents: 1668
diff changeset
1124 idl and php files, and should also work with java.
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1125
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
1126 There are a few of ways to turn on doxygen formatting. It can be done
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
1127 explicitly or in a modeline by appending '.doxygen' to the syntax of the file.
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
1128 Example: >
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1129 :set syntax=c.doxygen
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1130 or >
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1131 // vim:syntax=c.doxygen
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1132
3356
b37888de599c Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
1133 It can also be done automatically for C, C++, C#, IDL and PHP files by setting
b37888de599c Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
1134 the global or buffer-local variable load_doxygen_syntax. This is done by
b37888de599c Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
1135 adding the following to your .vimrc. >
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1136 :let g:load_doxygen_syntax=1
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1137
2207
b17bbfa96fa0 Add the settabvar() and gettabvar() functions.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2178
diff changeset
1138 There are a couple of variables that have an effect on syntax highlighting, and
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1139 are to do with non-standard highlighting options.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1140
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1141 Variable Default Effect ~
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1142 g:doxygen_enhanced_color
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1143 g:doxygen_enhanced_colour 0 Use non-standard highlighting for
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1144 doxygen comments.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1145
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1146 doxygen_my_rendering 0 Disable rendering of HTML bold, italic
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1147 and html_my_rendering underline.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1148
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1149 doxygen_javadoc_autobrief 1 Set to 0 to disable javadoc autobrief
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1150 colour highlighting.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1151
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1152 doxygen_end_punctuation '[.]' Set to regexp match for the ending
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
1153 punctuation of brief
832
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1154
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1155 There are also some hilight groups worth mentioning as they can be useful in
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1156 configuration.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1157
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1158 Highlight Effect ~
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1159 doxygenErrorComment The colour of an end-comment when missing
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1160 punctuation in a code, verbatim or dot section
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1161 doxygenLinkError The colour of an end-comment when missing the
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1162 \endlink from a \link section.
c76f780d4e05 updated for version 7.0d05
vimboss
parents: 829
diff changeset
1163
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1164
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1165 DTD *dtd.vim* *ft-dtd-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1166
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1167 The DTD syntax highlighting is case sensitive by default. To disable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1168 case-sensitive highlighting, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1169
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1170 :let dtd_ignore_case=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1171
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1172 The DTD syntax file will highlight unknown tags as errors. If
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1173 this is annoying, it can be turned off by setting: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1174
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1175 :let dtd_no_tag_errors=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1176
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1177 before sourcing the dtd.vim syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1178 Parameter entity names are highlighted in the definition using the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1179 'Type' highlighting group and 'Comment' for punctuation and '%'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1180 Parameter entity instances are highlighted using the 'Constant'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1181 highlighting group and the 'Type' highlighting group for the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1182 delimiters % and ;. This can be turned off by setting: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1183
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1184 :let dtd_no_param_entities=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1185
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1186 The DTD syntax file is also included by xml.vim to highlight included dtd's.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1188
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1189 EIFFEL *eiffel.vim* *ft-eiffel-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1190
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1191 While Eiffel is not case-sensitive, its style guidelines are, and the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1192 syntax highlighting file encourages their use. This also allows to
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1193 highlight class names differently. If you want to disable case-sensitive
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1194 highlighting, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1195
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1196 :let eiffel_ignore_case=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1197
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1198 Case still matters for class names and TODO marks in comments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1199
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1200 Conversely, for even stricter checks, add one of the following lines: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1201
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1202 :let eiffel_strict=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1203 :let eiffel_pedantic=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1205 Setting eiffel_strict will only catch improper capitalization for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1206 five predefined words "Current", "Void", "Result", "Precursor", and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1207 "NONE", to warn against their accidental use as feature or class names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1209 Setting eiffel_pedantic will enforce adherence to the Eiffel style
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1210 guidelines fairly rigorously (like arbitrary mixes of upper- and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1211 lowercase letters as well as outdated ways to capitalize keywords).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1212
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1213 If you want to use the lower-case version of "Current", "Void",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1214 "Result", and "Precursor", you can use >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1215
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1216 :let eiffel_lower_case_predef=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1217
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1218 instead of completely turning case-sensitive highlighting off.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1219
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1220 Support for ISE's proposed new creation syntax that is already
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1221 experimentally handled by some compilers can be enabled by: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1222
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1223 :let eiffel_ise=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1224
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1225 Finally, some vendors support hexadecimal constants. To handle them, add >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1226
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1227 :let eiffel_hex_constants=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1228
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1229 to your startup file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1230
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1231
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1232 ERLANG *erlang.vim* *ft-erlang-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1233
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1234 The erlang highlighting supports Erlang (ERicsson LANGuage).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1235 Erlang is case sensitive and default extension is ".erl".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1237 If you want to disable keywords highlighting, put in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1238 :let erlang_keywords = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1239 If you want to disable built-in-functions highlighting, put in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1240 .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1241 :let erlang_functions = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1242 If you want to disable special characters highlighting, put in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1243 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1244 :let erlang_characters = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1245
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1246
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1247 FLEXWIKI *flexwiki.vim* *ft-flexwiki-syntax*
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1248
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1249 FlexWiki is an ASP.NET-based wiki package available at http://www.flexwiki.com
2826
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
1250 NOTE: this site currently doesn't work, on Wikipedia is mentioned that
3c7da93eb7f9 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2788
diff changeset
1251 development stopped in 2009.
857
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1252
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1253 Syntax highlighting is available for the most common elements of FlexWiki
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1254 syntax. The associated ftplugin script sets some buffer-local options to make
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1255 editing FlexWiki pages more convenient. FlexWiki considers a newline as the
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1256 start of a new paragraph, so the ftplugin sets 'tw'=0 (unlimited line length),
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1257 'wrap' (wrap long lines instead of using horizontal scrolling), 'linebreak'
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1258 (to wrap at a character in 'breakat' instead of at the last char on screen),
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1259 and so on. It also includes some keymaps that are disabled by default.
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1260
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1261 If you want to enable the keymaps that make "j" and "k" and the cursor keys
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1262 move up and down by display lines, add this to your .vimrc: >
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1263 :let flexwiki_maps = 1
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1264
b933657f7c9d updated for version 7.0g01
vimboss
parents: 856
diff changeset
1265
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1266 FORM *form.vim* *ft-form-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1267
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1268 The coloring scheme for syntax elements in the FORM file uses the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1269 modes Conditional, Number, Statement, Comment, PreProc, Type, and String,
1275
d787f6c4c481 updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1224
diff changeset
1270 following the language specifications in 'Symbolic Manipulation with FORM' by
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1271 J.A.M. Vermaseren, CAN, Netherlands, 1991.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1272
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1273 If you want include your own changes to the default colors, you have to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1274 redefine the following syntax groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1275
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1276 - formConditional
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1277 - formNumber
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1278 - formStatement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1279 - formHeaderStatement
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1280 - formComment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1281 - formPreProc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1282 - formDirective
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1283 - formType
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1284 - formString
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1285
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1286 Note that the form.vim syntax file implements FORM preprocessor commands and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1287 directives per default in the same syntax group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1288
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1289 A predefined enhanced color mode for FORM is available to distinguish between
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1290 header statements and statements in the body of a FORM program. To activate
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1291 this mode define the following variable in your vimrc file >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1292
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1293 :let form_enhanced_color=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1294
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1295 The enhanced mode also takes advantage of additional color features for a dark
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1296 gvim display. Here, statements are colored LightYellow instead of Yellow, and
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1297 conditionals are LightBlue for better distinction.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1298
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1299
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1300 FORTRAN *fortran.vim* *ft-fortran-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1301
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1302 Default highlighting and dialect ~
3256
ba708ee8d69d Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
1303 Highlighting appropriate for Fortran 2008 is used by default. This choice
ba708ee8d69d Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
1304 should be appropriate for most users most of the time because Fortran 2008 is
ba708ee8d69d Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3237
diff changeset
1305 almost a superset of previous versions (Fortran 2003, 95, 90, and 77).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1306
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1307 Fortran source code form ~
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1308 Fortran code can be in either fixed or free source form. Note that the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1309 syntax highlighting will not be correct if the form is incorrectly set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1310
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1311 When you create a new fortran file, the syntax script assumes fixed source
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1312 form. If you always use free source form, then >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1313 :let fortran_free_source=1
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1314 in your .vimrc prior to the :syntax on command. If you always use fixed source
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1315 form, then >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1316 :let fortran_fixed_source=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1317 in your .vimrc prior to the :syntax on command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1318
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1319 If the form of the source code depends upon the file extension, then it is
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1320 most convenient to set fortran_free_source in a ftplugin file. For more
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1321 information on ftplugin files, see |ftplugin|. For example, if all your
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1322 fortran files with an .f90 extension are written in free source form and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1323 rest in fixed source form, add the following code to your ftplugin file >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1324 let s:extfname = expand("%:e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1325 if s:extfname ==? "f90"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1326 let fortran_free_source=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1327 unlet! fortran_fixed_source
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1328 else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1329 let fortran_fixed_source=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1330 unlet! fortran_free_source
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1331 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1332 Note that this will work only if the "filetype plugin indent on" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1333 precedes the "syntax on" command in your .vimrc file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1335 When you edit an existing fortran file, the syntax script will assume free
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1336 source form if the fortran_free_source variable has been set, and assumes
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1337 fixed source form if the fortran_fixed_source variable has been set. If
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1338 neither of these variables have been set, the syntax script attempts to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1339 determine which source form has been used by examining the first five columns
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
1340 of the first 250 lines of your file. If no signs of free source form are
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1341 detected, then the file is assumed to be in fixed source form. The algorithm
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1342 should work in the vast majority of cases. In some cases, such as a file that
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
1343 begins with 250 or more full-line comments, the script may incorrectly decide
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1344 that the fortran code is in fixed form. If that happens, just add a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1345 non-comment statement beginning anywhere in the first five columns of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1346 first twenty five lines, save (:w) and then reload (:e!) the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1347
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1348 Tabs in fortran files ~
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1349 Tabs are not recognized by the Fortran standards. Tabs are not a good idea in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1350 fixed format fortran source code which requires fixed column boundaries.
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1351 Therefore, tabs are marked as errors. Nevertheless, some programmers like
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1352 using tabs. If your fortran files contain tabs, then you should set the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1353 variable fortran_have_tabs in your .vimrc with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1354 :let fortran_have_tabs=1
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1355 placed prior to the :syntax on command. Unfortunately, the use of tabs will
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1356 mean that the syntax file will not be able to detect incorrect margins.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1357
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1358 Syntax folding of fortran files ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1359 If you wish to use foldmethod=syntax, then you must first set the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1360 fortran_fold with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1361 :let fortran_fold=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1362 to instruct the syntax script to define fold regions for program units, that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1363 is main programs starting with a program statement, subroutines, function
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1364 subprograms, block data subprograms, interface blocks, and modules. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1365 also set the variable fortran_fold_conditionals with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1366 :let fortran_fold_conditionals=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1367 then fold regions will also be defined for do loops, if blocks, and select
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1368 case constructs. If you also set the variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1369 fortran_fold_multilinecomments with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1370 :let fortran_fold_multilinecomments=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1371 then fold regions will also be defined for three or more consecutive comment
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1372 lines. Note that defining fold regions can be slow for large files.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1373
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1374 If fortran_fold, and possibly fortran_fold_conditionals and/or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1375 fortran_fold_multilinecomments, have been set, then vim will fold your file if
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1376 you set foldmethod=syntax. Comments or blank lines placed between two program
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1377 units are not folded because they are seen as not belonging to any program
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1378 unit.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1379
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1380 More precise fortran syntax ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1381 If you set the variable fortran_more_precise with a command such as >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1382 :let fortran_more_precise=1
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1383 then the syntax coloring will be more precise but slower. In particular,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1384 statement labels used in do, goto and arithmetic if statements will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1385 recognized, as will construct names at the end of a do, if, select or forall
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1386 construct.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1388 Non-default fortran dialects ~
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1389 The syntax script supports two Fortran dialects: f08 and F. You will probably
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1390 find the default highlighting (f08) satisfactory. A few legacy constructs
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1391 deleted or declared obsolescent in the 2008 standard are highlighted as todo
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1392 items.
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1393
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1394 If you use F, the advantage of setting the dialect appropriately is that
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1395 other legacy features excluded from F will be highlighted as todo items and
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1396 that free source form will be assumed.
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1397
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1398 The dialect can be selected in various ways. If all your fortran files use
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1399 the same dialect, set the global variable fortran_dialect in your .vimrc prior
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1400 to your syntax on statement. The case-sensitive, permissible values of
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1401 fortran_dialect are "f08" or "F". Invalid values of fortran_dialect are
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1402 ignored.
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1403
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1404 If the dialect depends upon the file extension, then it is most convenient to
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1405 set a buffer-local variable in a ftplugin file. For more information on
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1406 ftplugin files, see |ftplugin|. For example, if all your fortran files with
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1407 an .f90 extension are written in the F subset, your ftplugin file should
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1408 contain the code >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1409 let s:extfname = expand("%:e")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1410 if s:extfname ==? "f90"
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1411 let b:fortran_dialect="F"
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1412 else
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1413 unlet! b:fortran_dialect
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1414 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1415 Note that this will work only if the "filetype plugin indent on" command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1416 precedes the "syntax on" command in your .vimrc file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1417
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1418 Finer control is necessary if the file extension does not uniquely identify
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1419 the dialect. You can override the default dialect, on a file-by-file basis,
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1420 by including a comment with the directive "fortran_dialect=xx" (where xx=F or
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1421 f08) in one of the first three lines in your file. For example, your older .f
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1422 files may be legacy code but your newer ones may be F codes, and you would
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1423 identify the latter by including in the first three lines of those files a
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1424 Fortran comment of the form >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1425 ! fortran_dialect=F
3281
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1426
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1427 For previous versions of the syntax, you may have set fortran_dialect to the
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1428 now-obsolete values "f77", "f90", "f95", or "elf". Such settings will be
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1429 silently handled as "f08". Users of "elf" may wish to experiment with "F"
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1430 instead.
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1431
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1432 The syntax/fortran.vim script contains embedded comments that tell you how to
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1433 comment and/or uncomment some lines to (a) activate recognition of some
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1434 non-standard, vendor-supplied intrinsics and (b) to prevent features deleted
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1435 or declared obsolescent in the 2008 standard from being highlighted as todo
af1e8a1714c2 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3256
diff changeset
1436 items.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1437
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1438 Limitations ~
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1439 Parenthesis checking does not catch too few closing parentheses. Hollerith
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1440 strings are not recognized. Some keywords may be highlighted incorrectly
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1441 because Fortran90 has no reserved words.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1442
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1443 For further information related to fortran, see |ft-fortran-indent| and
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1444 |ft-fortran-plugin|.
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1445
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1446
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1447 FVWM CONFIGURATION FILES *fvwm.vim* *ft-fvwm-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1448
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1449 In order for Vim to recognize Fvwm configuration files that do not match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1450 the patterns *fvwmrc* or *fvwm2rc* , you must put additional patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1451 appropriate to your system in your myfiletypes.vim file. For these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1452 patterns, you must set the variable "b:fvwm_version" to the major version
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1453 number of Fvwm, and the 'filetype' option to fvwm.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1454
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1455 For example, to make Vim identify all files in /etc/X11/fvwm2/
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1456 as Fvwm2 configuration files, add the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1457
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1458 :au! BufNewFile,BufRead /etc/X11/fvwm2/* let b:fvwm_version = 2 |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1459 \ set filetype=fvwm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1461 If you'd like Vim to highlight all valid color names, tell it where to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1462 find the color database (rgb.txt) on your system. Do this by setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1463 "rgb_file" to its location. Assuming your color database is located
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1464 in /usr/X11/lib/X11/, you should add the line >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1465
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1466 :let rgb_file = "/usr/X11/lib/X11/rgb.txt"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1467
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1468 to your .vimrc file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1469
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1470
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1471 GSP *gsp.vim* *ft-gsp-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1472
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1473 The default coloring style for GSP pages is defined by |html.vim|, and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1474 the coloring for java code (within java tags or inline between backticks)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1475 is defined by |java.vim|. The following HTML groups defined in |html.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1476 are redefined to incorporate and highlight inline java code:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1477
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1478 htmlString
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1479 htmlValue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1480 htmlEndTag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1481 htmlTag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1482 htmlTagN
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1483
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1484 Highlighting should look fine most of the places where you'd see inline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1485 java code, but in some special cases it may not. To add another HTML
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1486 group where you will have inline java code where it does not highlight
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1487 correctly, just copy the line you want from |html.vim| and add gspJava
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1488 to the contains clause.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1489
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1490 The backticks for inline java are highlighted according to the htmlError
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1491 group to make them easier to see.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1492
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1493
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1494 GROFF *groff.vim* *ft-groff-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1495
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1496 The groff syntax file is a wrapper for |nroff.vim|, see the notes
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1497 under that heading for examples of use and configuration. The purpose
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1498 of this wrapper is to set up groff syntax extensions by setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1499 filetype from a |modeline| or in a personal filetype definitions file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1500 (see |filetype.txt|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1501
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1502
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1503 HASKELL *haskell.vim* *lhaskell.vim* *ft-haskell-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1504
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1505 The Haskell syntax files support plain Haskell code as well as literate
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1506 Haskell code, the latter in both Bird style and TeX style. The Haskell
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1507 syntax highlighting will also highlight C preprocessor directives.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1509 If you want to highlight delimiter characters (useful if you have a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1510 light-coloured background), add to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1511 :let hs_highlight_delimiters = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1512 To treat True and False as keywords as opposed to ordinary identifiers,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1513 add: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1514 :let hs_highlight_boolean = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1515 To also treat the names of primitive types as keywords: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1516 :let hs_highlight_types = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1517 And to treat the names of even more relatively common types as keywords: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1518 :let hs_highlight_more_types = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1519 If you want to highlight the names of debugging functions, put in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1520 your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1521 :let hs_highlight_debug = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1522
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1523 The Haskell syntax highlighting also highlights C preprocessor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1524 directives, and flags lines that start with # but are not valid
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1525 directives as erroneous. This interferes with Haskell's syntax for
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1526 operators, as they may start with #. If you want to highlight those
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1527 as operators as opposed to errors, put in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1528 :let hs_allow_hash_operator = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1529
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1530 The syntax highlighting for literate Haskell code will try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1531 automatically guess whether your literate Haskell code contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1532 TeX markup or not, and correspondingly highlight TeX constructs
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1533 or nothing at all. You can override this globally by putting
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1534 in your .vimrc >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1535 :let lhs_markup = none
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1536 for no highlighting at all, or >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1537 :let lhs_markup = tex
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1538 to force the highlighting to always try to highlight TeX markup.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1539 For more flexibility, you may also use buffer local versions of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1540 this variable, so e.g. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1541 :let b:lhs_markup = tex
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1542 will force TeX highlighting for a particular buffer. It has to be
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1543 set before turning syntax highlighting on for the buffer or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1544 loading a file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1545
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1546
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1547 HTML *html.vim* *ft-html-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1548
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1549 The coloring scheme for tags in the HTML file works as follows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1550
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1551 The <> of opening tags are colored differently than the </> of a closing tag.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1552 This is on purpose! For opening tags the 'Function' color is used, while for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1553 closing tags the 'Type' color is used (See syntax.vim to check how those are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1554 defined for you)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1555
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1556 Known tag names are colored the same way as statements in C. Unknown tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1557 names are colored with the same color as the <> or </> respectively which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1558 makes it easy to spot errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1559
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1560 Note that the same is true for argument (or attribute) names. Known attribute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1561 names are colored differently than unknown ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1562
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1563 Some HTML tags are used to change the rendering of text. The following tags
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1564 are recognized by the html.vim syntax coloring file and change the way normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1565 text is shown: <B> <I> <U> <EM> <STRONG> (<EM> is used as an alias for <I>,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1566 while <STRONG> as an alias for <B>), <H1> - <H6>, <HEAD>, <TITLE> and <A>, but
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1567 only if used as a link (that is, it must include a href as in
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
1568 <A href="somefile.html">).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1569
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1570 If you want to change how such text is rendered, you must redefine the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1571 following syntax groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1572
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1573 - htmlBold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1574 - htmlBoldUnderline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1575 - htmlBoldUnderlineItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1576 - htmlUnderline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1577 - htmlUnderlineItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1578 - htmlItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1579 - htmlTitle for titles
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1580 - htmlH1 - htmlH6 for headings
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1581
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1582 To make this redefinition work you must redefine them all with the exception
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1583 of the last two (htmlTitle and htmlH[1-6], which are optional) and define the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1584 following variable in your vimrc (this is due to the order in which the files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1585 are read during initialization) >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1586 :let html_my_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1587
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1588 If you'd like to see an example download mysyntax.vim at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1589 http://www.fleiner.com/vim/download.html
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1590
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1591 You can also disable this rendering by adding the following line to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1592 vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1593 :let html_no_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1594
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1595 HTML comments are rather special (see an HTML reference document for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1596 details), and the syntax coloring scheme will highlight all errors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1597 However, if you prefer to use the wrong style (starts with <!-- and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1598 ends with --!>) you can define >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1599 :let html_wrong_comments=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1600
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1601 JavaScript and Visual Basic embedded inside HTML documents are highlighted as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1602 'Special' with statements, comments, strings and so on colored as in standard
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1603 programming languages. Note that only JavaScript and Visual Basic are currently
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1604 supported, no other scripting language has been added yet.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1605
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1606 Embedded and inlined cascading style sheets (CSS) are highlighted too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1607
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1608 There are several html preprocessor languages out there. html.vim has been
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1609 written such that it should be trivial to include it. To do so add the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1610 following two lines to the syntax coloring file for that language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1611 (the example comes from the asp.vim file):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1612
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1613 runtime! syntax/html.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1614 syn cluster htmlPreproc add=asp
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1615
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1616 Now you just need to make sure that you add all regions that contain
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1617 the preprocessor language to the cluster htmlPreproc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1618
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1619
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1620 HTML/OS (by Aestiva) *htmlos.vim* *ft-htmlos-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1621
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1622 The coloring scheme for HTML/OS works as follows:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1623
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1624 Functions and variable names are the same color by default, because VIM
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1625 doesn't specify different colors for Functions and Identifiers. To change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1626 this (which is recommended if you want function names to be recognizable in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1627 different color) you need to add the following line to either your ~/.vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1628 :hi Function term=underline cterm=bold ctermfg=LightGray
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1629
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1630 Of course, the ctermfg can be a different color if you choose.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1631
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1632 Another issues that HTML/OS runs into is that there is no special filetype to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1633 signify that it is a file with HTML/OS coding. You can change this by opening
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1634 a file and turning on HTML/OS syntax by doing the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1635 :set syntax=htmlos
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1636
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1637 Lastly, it should be noted that the opening and closing characters to begin a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1638 block of HTML/OS code can either be << or [[ and >> or ]], respectively.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1639
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1640
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1641 IA64 *ia64.vim* *intel-itanium* *ft-ia64-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1642
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1643 Highlighting for the Intel Itanium 64 assembly language. See |asm.vim| for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1644 how to recognize this filetype.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1645
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1646 To have *.inc files be recognized as IA64, add this to your .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1647 :let g:filetype_inc = "ia64"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1648
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1649
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1650 INFORM *inform.vim* *ft-inform-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1651
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1652 Inform highlighting includes symbols provided by the Inform Library, as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1653 most programs make extensive use of it. If do not wish Library symbols
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1654 to be highlighted add this to your vim startup: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1655 :let inform_highlight_simple=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1656
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1657 By default it is assumed that Inform programs are Z-machine targeted,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1658 and highlights Z-machine assembly language symbols appropriately. If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1659 you intend your program to be targeted to a Glulx/Glk environment you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1660 need to add this to your startup sequence: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1661 :let inform_highlight_glulx=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1662
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1663 This will highlight Glulx opcodes instead, and also adds glk() to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1664 set of highlighted system functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1665
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1666 The Inform compiler will flag certain obsolete keywords as errors when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1667 it encounters them. These keywords are normally highlighted as errors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1668 by Vim. To prevent such error highlighting, you must add this to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1669 startup sequence: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1670 :let inform_suppress_obsolete=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1671
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1672 By default, the language features highlighted conform to Compiler
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1673 version 6.30 and Library version 6.11. If you are using an older
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1674 Inform development environment, you may with to add this to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1675 startup sequence: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1676 :let inform_highlight_old=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1677
829
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1678 IDL *idl.vim* *idl-syntax*
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1679
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1680 IDL (Interface Definition Language) files are used to define RPC calls. In
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1681 Microsoft land, this is also used for defining COM interfaces and calls.
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1682
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1683 IDL's structure is simple enough to permit a full grammar based approach to
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1684 rather than using a few heuristics. The result is large and somewhat
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
1685 repetitive but seems to work.
829
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1686
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1687 There are some Microsoft extensions to idl files that are here. Some of them
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1688 are disabled by defining idl_no_ms_extensions.
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1689
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1690 The more complex of the extensions are disabled by defining idl_no_extensions.
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1691
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1692 Variable Effect ~
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1693
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1694 idl_no_ms_extensions Disable some of the Microsoft specific
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1695 extensions
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1696 idl_no_extensions Disable complex extensions
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1697 idlsyntax_showerror Show IDL errors (can be rather intrusive, but
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1698 quite helpful)
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1699 idlsyntax_showerror_soft Use softer colours by default for errors
dc8197342755 updated for version 7.0d04
vimboss
parents: 828
diff changeset
1700
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1701
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1702 JAVA *java.vim* *ft-java-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1703
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1704 The java.vim syntax highlighting file offers several options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1705
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1706 In Java 1.0.2 it was never possible to have braces inside parens, so this was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1707 flagged as an error. Since Java 1.1 this is possible (with anonymous
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1708 classes), and therefore is no longer marked as an error. If you prefer the old
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1709 way, put the following line into your vim startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1710 :let java_mark_braces_in_parens_as_errors=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1711
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1712 All identifiers in java.lang.* are always visible in all classes. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1713 highlight them use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1714 :let java_highlight_java_lang_ids=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1715
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1716 You can also highlight identifiers of most standard Java packages if you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1717 download the javaid.vim script at http://www.fleiner.com/vim/download.html.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1718 If you prefer to only highlight identifiers of a certain package, say java.io
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1719 use the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1720 :let java_highlight_java_io=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1721 Check the javaid.vim file for a list of all the packages that are supported.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1722
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1723 Function names are not highlighted, as the way to find functions depends on
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1724 how you write Java code. The syntax file knows two possible ways to highlight
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1725 functions:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1726
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1727 If you write function declarations that are always indented by either
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1728 a tab, 8 spaces or 2 spaces you may want to set >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1729 :let java_highlight_functions="indent"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1730 However, if you follow the Java guidelines about how functions and classes are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1731 supposed to be named (with respect to upper and lowercase), use >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1732 :let java_highlight_functions="style"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1733 If both options do not work for you, but you would still want function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1734 declarations to be highlighted create your own definitions by changing the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1735 definitions in java.vim or by creating your own java.vim which includes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1736 original one and then adds the code to highlight functions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1737
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1738 In Java 1.1 the functions System.out.println() and System.err.println() should
8
7edf9b6e4c36 Various changes
vimboss
parents: 7
diff changeset
1739 only be used for debugging. Therefore it is possible to highlight debugging
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1740 statements differently. To do this you must add the following definition in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1741 your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1742 :let java_highlight_debug=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1743 The result will be that those statements are highlighted as 'Special'
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1744 characters. If you prefer to have them highlighted differently you must define
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1745 new highlightings for the following groups.:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1746 Debug, DebugSpecial, DebugString, DebugBoolean, DebugType
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1747 which are used for the statement itself, special characters used in debug
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1748 strings, strings, boolean constants and types (this, super) respectively. I
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1749 have opted to chose another background for those statements.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1750
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1751 Javadoc is a program that takes special comments out of Java program files and
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1752 creates HTML pages. The standard configuration will highlight this HTML code
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1753 similarly to HTML files (see |html.vim|). You can even add Javascript
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1754 and CSS inside this code (see below). There are four differences however:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1755 1. The title (all characters up to the first '.' which is followed by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1756 some white space or up to the first '@') is colored differently (to change
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1757 the color change the group CommentTitle).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1758 2. The text is colored as 'Comment'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1759 3. HTML comments are colored as 'Special'
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1760 4. The special Javadoc tags (@see, @param, ...) are highlighted as specials
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1761 and the argument (for @see, @param, @exception) as Function.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1762 To turn this feature off add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1763 :let java_ignore_javadoc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1764
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1765 If you use the special Javadoc comment highlighting described above you
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1766 can also turn on special highlighting for Javascript, visual basic
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1767 scripts and embedded CSS (stylesheets). This makes only sense if you
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1768 actually have Javadoc comments that include either Javascript or embedded
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1769 CSS. The options to use are >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1770 :let java_javascript=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1771 :let java_css=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1772 :let java_vb=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1773
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1774 In order to highlight nested parens with different colors define colors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1775 for javaParen, javaParen1 and javaParen2, for example with >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1776 :hi link javaParen Comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1777 or >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1778 :hi javaParen ctermfg=blue guifg=#0000ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1779
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1780 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1781 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "java_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1782 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1783 :let java_minlines = 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1784 This will make the syntax synchronization start 50 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1785 displayed line. The default value is 10. The disadvantage of using a larger
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1786 number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1787
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1788
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1789 LACE *lace.vim* *ft-lace-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1790
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1791 Lace (Language for Assembly of Classes in Eiffel) is case insensitive, but the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1792 style guide lines are not. If you prefer case insensitive highlighting, just
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1793 define the vim variable 'lace_case_insensitive' in your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1794 :let lace_case_insensitive=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1795
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1796
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1797 LEX *lex.vim* *ft-lex-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1798
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1799 Lex uses brute-force synchronizing as the "^%%$" section delimiter
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1800 gives no clue as to what section follows. Consequently, the value for >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1801 :syn sync minlines=300
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1802 may be changed by the user if s/he is experiencing synchronization
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1803 difficulties (such as may happen with large lex files).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1804
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1805
2412
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1806 LIFELINES *lifelines.vim* *ft-lifelines-syntax*
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1807
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1808 To highlight deprecated functions as errors, add in your .vimrc: >
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1809
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1810 :let g:lifelines_deprecated = 1
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1811 <
ca3f40b0d95e Prepare for 7.3b release. Fix src/Makefile enabling python3 by default.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2410
diff changeset
1812
555
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1813 LISP *lisp.vim* *ft-lisp-syntax*
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1814
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1815 The lisp syntax highlighting provides two options: >
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1816
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1817 g:lisp_instring : if it exists, then "(...)" strings are highlighted
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1818 as if the contents of the string were lisp.
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1819 Useful for AutoLisp.
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1820 g:lisp_rainbow : if it exists and is nonzero, then differing levels
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1821 of parenthesization will receive different
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1822 highlighting.
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1823 <
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1824 The g:lisp_rainbow option provides 10 levels of individual colorization for
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1825 the parentheses and backquoted parentheses. Because of the quantity of
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1826 colorization levels, unlike non-rainbow highlighting, the rainbow mode
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1827 specifies its highlighting using ctermfg and guifg, thereby bypassing the
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1828 usual colorscheme control using standard highlighting groups. The actual
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1829 highlighting used depends on the dark/bright setting (see |'bg'|).
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1830
a5efb97bc104 updated for version 7.0157
vimboss
parents: 540
diff changeset
1831
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1832 LITE *lite.vim* *ft-lite-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1833
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1834 There are two options for the lite syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1835
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1836 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1837
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1838 :let lite_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1839
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1840 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1841 set "lite_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1842
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1843 :let lite_minlines = 200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1844
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1845
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1846 LPC *lpc.vim* *ft-lpc-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1847
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1848 LPC stands for a simple, memory-efficient language: Lars Pensj| C. The
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1849 file name of LPC is usually *.c. Recognizing these files as LPC would bother
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1850 users writing only C programs. If you want to use LPC syntax in Vim, you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1851 should set a variable in your .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1852
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1853 :let lpc_syntax_for_c = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1854
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1855 If it doesn't work properly for some particular C or LPC files, use a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1856 modeline. For a LPC file:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1857
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1858 // vim:set ft=lpc:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1859
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1860 For a C file that is recognized as LPC:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1861
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1862 // vim:set ft=c:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1863
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1864 If you don't want to set the variable, use the modeline in EVERY LPC file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1865
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1866 There are several implementations for LPC, we intend to support most widely
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1867 used ones. Here the default LPC syntax is for MudOS series, for MudOS v22
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1868 and before, you should turn off the sensible modifiers, and this will also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1869 asserts the new efuns after v22 to be invalid, don't set this variable when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1870 you are using the latest version of MudOS: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1871
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1872 :let lpc_pre_v22 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1873
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1874 For LpMud 3.2 series of LPC: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1875
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1876 :let lpc_compat_32 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1877
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1878 For LPC4 series of LPC: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1879
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1880 :let lpc_use_lpc4_syntax = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1881
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1882 For uLPC series of LPC:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1883 uLPC has been developed to Pike, so you should use Pike syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1884 instead, and the name of your source file should be *.pike
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1885
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1886
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1887 LUA *lua.vim* *ft-lua-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1888
3356
b37888de599c Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
1889 The Lua syntax file can be used for versions 4.0, 5.0, 5.1 and 5.2 (5.2 is
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1890 the default). You can select one of these versions using the global variables
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1891 lua_version and lua_subversion. For example, to activate Lua
3356
b37888de599c Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3281
diff changeset
1892 5.1 syntax highlighting, set the variables like this:
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1893
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1894 :let lua_version = 5
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
1895 :let lua_subversion = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1896
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1897
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1898 MAIL *mail.vim* *ft-mail.vim*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1899
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1900 Vim highlights all the standard elements of an email (headers, signatures,
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1901 quoted text and URLs / email addresses). In keeping with standard conventions,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1902 signatures begin in a line containing only "--" followed optionally by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1903 whitespaces and end with a newline.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1904
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1905 Vim treats lines beginning with ']', '}', '|', '>' or a word followed by '>'
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1906 as quoted text. However Vim highlights headers and signatures in quoted text
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1907 only if the text is quoted with '>' (optionally followed by one space).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1908
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1909 By default mail.vim synchronises syntax to 100 lines before the first
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1910 displayed line. If you have a slow machine, and generally deal with emails
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1911 with short headers, you can change this to a smaller value: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1912
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1913 :let mail_minlines = 30
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1914
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1915
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1916 MAKE *make.vim* *ft-make-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1917
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1918 In makefiles, commands are usually highlighted to make it easy for you to spot
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1919 errors. However, this may be too much coloring for you. You can turn this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1920 feature off by using: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1921
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1922 :let make_no_commands = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1923
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1924
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1925 MAPLE *maple.vim* *ft-maple-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1926
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1927 Maple V, by Waterloo Maple Inc, supports symbolic algebra. The language
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1928 supports many packages of functions which are selectively loaded by the user.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1929 The standard set of packages' functions as supplied in Maple V release 4 may be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1930 highlighted at the user's discretion. Users may place in their .vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1931
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1932 :let mvpkg_all= 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1933
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1934 to get all package functions highlighted, or users may select any subset by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1935 choosing a variable/package from the table below and setting that variable to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1936 1, also in their .vimrc file (prior to sourcing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1937 $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/syntax.vim).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1938
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1939 Table of Maple V Package Function Selectors >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1940 mv_DEtools mv_genfunc mv_networks mv_process
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1941 mv_Galois mv_geometry mv_numapprox mv_simplex
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1942 mv_GaussInt mv_grobner mv_numtheory mv_stats
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1943 mv_LREtools mv_group mv_orthopoly mv_student
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1944 mv_combinat mv_inttrans mv_padic mv_sumtools
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1945 mv_combstruct mv_liesymm mv_plots mv_tensor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1946 mv_difforms mv_linalg mv_plottools mv_totorder
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1947 mv_finance mv_logic mv_powseries
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1948
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1949
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1950 MATHEMATICA *mma.vim* *ft-mma-syntax* *ft-mathematica-syntax*
271
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1951
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1952 Empty *.m files will automatically be presumed to be Matlab files unless you
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1953 have the following in your .vimrc: >
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1954
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1955 let filetype_m = "mma"
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1956
8d34af900bae updated for version 7.0072
vimboss
parents: 237
diff changeset
1957
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1958 MOO *moo.vim* *ft-moo-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1959
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1960 If you use C-style comments inside expressions and find it mangles your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1961 highlighting, you may want to use extended (slow!) matches for C-style
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1962 comments: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1963
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1964 :let moo_extended_cstyle_comments = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1965
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1966 To disable highlighting of pronoun substitution patterns inside strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1967
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1968 :let moo_no_pronoun_sub = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1969
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1970 To disable highlighting of the regular expression operator '%|', and matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1971 '%(' and '%)' inside strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1972
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1973 :let moo_no_regexp = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1974
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1975 Unmatched double quotes can be recognized and highlighted as errors: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1976
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1977 :let moo_unmatched_quotes = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1978
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1979 To highlight builtin properties (.name, .location, .programmer etc.): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1980
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1981 :let moo_builtin_properties = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1982
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
1983 Unknown builtin functions can be recognized and highlighted as errors. If you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1984 use this option, add your own extensions to the mooKnownBuiltinFunction group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1985 To enable this option: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1986
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1987 :let moo_unknown_builtin_functions = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1988
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1989 An example of adding sprintf() to the list of known builtin functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1990
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1991 :syn keyword mooKnownBuiltinFunction sprintf contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1992
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1993
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
1994 MSQL *msql.vim* *ft-msql-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1995
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1996 There are two options for the msql syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1997
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1998 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
1999
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2000 :let msql_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2002 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2003 set "msql_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2004
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2005 :let msql_minlines = 200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2006
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2007
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2008 NCF *ncf.vim* *ft-ncf-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2009
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2010 There is one option for NCF syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2011
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2012 If you want to have unrecognized (by ncf.vim) statements highlighted as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2013 errors, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2015 :let ncf_highlight_unknowns = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2016
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2017 If you don't want to highlight these errors, leave it unset.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2018
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2019
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2020 NROFF *nroff.vim* *ft-nroff-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2021
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2022 The nroff syntax file works with AT&T n/troff out of the box. You need to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2023 activate the GNU groff extra features included in the syntax file before you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2024 can use them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2025
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2026 For example, Linux and BSD distributions use groff as their default text
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2027 processing package. In order to activate the extra syntax highlighting
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2028 features for groff, add the following option to your start-up files: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2029
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2030 :let b:nroff_is_groff = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2031
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2032 Groff is different from the old AT&T n/troff that you may still find in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2033 Solaris. Groff macro and request names can be longer than 2 characters and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2034 there are extensions to the language primitives. For example, in AT&T troff
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2035 you access the year as a 2-digit number with the request \(yr. In groff you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2036 can use the same request, recognized for compatibility, or you can use groff's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2037 native syntax, \[yr]. Furthermore, you can use a 4-digit year directly:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2038 \[year]. Macro requests can be longer than 2 characters, for example, GNU mm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2039 accepts the requests ".VERBON" and ".VERBOFF" for creating verbatim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2040 environments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2041
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2042 In order to obtain the best formatted output g/troff can give you, you should
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2043 follow a few simple rules about spacing and punctuation.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2044
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2045 1. Do not leave empty spaces at the end of lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2046
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2047 2. Leave one space and one space only after an end-of-sentence period,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2048 exclamation mark, etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2049
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2050 3. For reasons stated below, it is best to follow all period marks with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2051 carriage return.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2052
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2053 The reason behind these unusual tips is that g/n/troff have a line breaking
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2054 algorithm that can be easily upset if you don't follow the rules given above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2055
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2056 Unlike TeX, troff fills text line-by-line, not paragraph-by-paragraph and,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2057 furthermore, it does not have a concept of glue or stretch, all horizontal and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2058 vertical space input will be output as is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2059
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2060 Therefore, you should be careful about not using more space between sentences
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2061 than you intend to have in your final document. For this reason, the common
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2062 practice is to insert a carriage return immediately after all punctuation
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2063 marks. If you want to have "even" text in your final processed output, you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2064 need to maintaining regular spacing in the input text. To mark both trailing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2065 spaces and two or more spaces after a punctuation as an error, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2066
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2067 :let nroff_space_errors = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2068
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2069 Another technique to detect extra spacing and other errors that will interfere
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2070 with the correct typesetting of your file, is to define an eye-catching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2071 highlighting definition for the syntax groups "nroffDefinition" and
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2072 "nroffDefSpecial" in your configuration files. For example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2073
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2074 hi def nroffDefinition term=italic cterm=italic gui=reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2075 hi def nroffDefSpecial term=italic,bold cterm=italic,bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2076 \ gui=reverse,bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2077
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2078 If you want to navigate preprocessor entries in your source file as easily as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2079 with section markers, you can activate the following option in your .vimrc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2080 file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2081
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2082 let b:preprocs_as_sections = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2083
9
4102fb4ea781 updated for version 7.0002
vimboss
parents: 8
diff changeset
2084 As well, the syntax file adds an extra paragraph marker for the extended
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2085 paragraph macro (.XP) in the ms package.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2086
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2087 Finally, there is a |groff.vim| syntax file that can be used for enabling
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2088 groff syntax highlighting either on a file basis or globally by default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2089
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2090
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2091 OCAML *ocaml.vim* *ft-ocaml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2092
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2093 The OCaml syntax file handles files having the following prefixes: .ml,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2094 .mli, .mll and .mly. By setting the following variable >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2095
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2096 :let ocaml_revised = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2097
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2098 you can switch from standard OCaml-syntax to revised syntax as supported
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2099 by the camlp4 preprocessor. Setting the variable >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2101 :let ocaml_noend_error = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2102
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2103 prevents highlighting of "end" as error, which is useful when sources
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2104 contain very long structures that Vim does not synchronize anymore.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2105
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2106
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2107 PAPP *papp.vim* *ft-papp-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2108
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2109 The PApp syntax file handles .papp files and, to a lesser extend, .pxml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2110 and .pxsl files which are all a mixture of perl/xml/html/other using xml
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2111 as the top-level file format. By default everything inside phtml or pxml
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2112 sections is treated as a string with embedded preprocessor commands. If
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2113 you set the variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2114
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2115 :let papp_include_html=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2116
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2117 in your startup file it will try to syntax-hilight html code inside phtml
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2118 sections, but this is relatively slow and much too colourful to be able to
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2119 edit sensibly. ;)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2120
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2121 The newest version of the papp.vim syntax file can usually be found at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2122 http://papp.plan9.de.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2123
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2124
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2125 PASCAL *pascal.vim* *ft-pascal-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2126
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2127 Files matching "*.p" could be Progress or Pascal. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2128 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit Progress at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2129 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2131 :let filetype_p = "pascal"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2132
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2133 The Pascal syntax file has been extended to take into account some extensions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2134 provided by Turbo Pascal, Free Pascal Compiler and GNU Pascal Compiler.
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2135 Delphi keywords are also supported. By default, Turbo Pascal 7.0 features are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2136 enabled. If you prefer to stick with the standard Pascal keywords, add the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2137 following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2138
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2139 :let pascal_traditional=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2140
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2141 To switch on Delphi specific constructions (such as one-line comments,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2142 keywords, etc): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2143
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2144 :let pascal_delphi=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2145
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2146
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2147 The option pascal_symbol_operator controls whether symbol operators such as +,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2148 *, .., etc. are displayed using the Operator color or not. To colorize symbol
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2149 operators, add the following line to your startup file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2150
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2151 :let pascal_symbol_operator=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2152
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2153 Some functions are highlighted by default. To switch it off: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2154
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2155 :let pascal_no_functions=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2156
2283
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2269
diff changeset
2157 Furthermore, there are specific variables for some compilers. Besides
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2158 pascal_delphi, there are pascal_gpc and pascal_fpc. Default extensions try to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2159 match Turbo Pascal. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2160
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2161 :let pascal_gpc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2162
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2163 or >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2164
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2165 :let pascal_fpc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2166
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2167 To ensure that strings are defined on a single line, you can define the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2168 pascal_one_line_string variable. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2169
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2170 :let pascal_one_line_string=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2171
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2172 If you dislike <Tab> chars, you can set the pascal_no_tabs variable. Tabs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2173 will be highlighted as Error. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2174
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2175 :let pascal_no_tabs=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2176
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2177
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2178
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2179 PERL *perl.vim* *ft-perl-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2180
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2181 There are a number of possible options to the perl syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2182
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2183 If you use POD files or POD segments, you might: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2184
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2185 :let perl_include_pod = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2186
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2187 The reduce the complexity of parsing (and increase performance) you can switch
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2188 off two elements in the parsing of variable names and contents. >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2189
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2190 To handle package references in variable and function names not differently
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2191 from the rest of the name (like 'PkgName::' in '$PkgName::VarName'): >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2192
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2193 :let perl_no_scope_in_variables = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2194
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2195 (In Vim 6.x it was the other way around: "perl_want_scope_in_variables"
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2196 enabled it.)
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2197
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2198 If you do not want complex things like '@{${"foo"}}' to be parsed: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2199
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2200 :let perl_no_extended_vars = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2201
26
404aac550f35 updated for version 7.0017
vimboss
parents: 24
diff changeset
2202 (In Vim 6.x it was the other way around: "perl_extended_vars" enabled it.)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2203
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2204 The coloring strings can be changed. By default strings and qq friends will be
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2205 highlighted like the first line. If you set the variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2206 perl_string_as_statement, it will be highlighted as in the second line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2207
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2208 "hello world!"; qq|hello world|;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2209 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^NN^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^N (unlet perl_string_as_statement)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2210 S^^^^^^^^^^^^SNNSSS^^^^^^^^^^^SN (let perl_string_as_statement)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2211
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2212 (^ = perlString, S = perlStatement, N = None at all)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2213
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2214 The syncing has 3 options. The first two switch off some triggering of
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2215 synchronization and should only be needed in case it fails to work properly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2216 If while scrolling all of a sudden the whole screen changes color completely
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2217 then you should try and switch off one of those. Let me know if you can figure
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2218 out the line that causes the mistake.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2219
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2220 One triggers on "^\s*sub\s*" and the other on "^[$@%]" more or less. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2221
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2222 :let perl_no_sync_on_sub
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2223 :let perl_no_sync_on_global_var
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2224
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2225 Below you can set the maximum distance VIM should look for starting points for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2226 its attempts in syntax highlighting. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2227
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2228 :let perl_sync_dist = 100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2229
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2230 If you want to use folding with perl, set perl_fold: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2231
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2232 :let perl_fold = 1
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2233
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2234 If you want to fold blocks in if statements, etc. as well set the following: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2235
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2236 :let perl_fold_blocks = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2237
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2238 To avoid folding packages or subs when perl_fold is let, let the appropriate
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2239 variable(s): >
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2240
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2241 :unlet perl_nofold_packages
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2242 :unlet perl_nofold_subs
632
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2243
b6632d553df3 updated for version 7.0182
vimboss
parents: 625
diff changeset
2244
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2245
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2246 PHP3 and PHP4 *php.vim* *php3.vim* *ft-php-syntax* *ft-php3-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2247
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2248 [note: previously this was called "php3", but since it now also supports php4
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2249 it has been renamed to "php"]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2250
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2251 There are the following options for the php syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2252
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2253 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2255 let php_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2257 For highlighting the Baselib methods: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2258
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2259 let php_baselib = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2260
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2261 Enable HTML syntax highlighting inside strings: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2262
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2263 let php_htmlInStrings = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2264
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2265 Using the old colorstyle: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2266
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2267 let php_oldStyle = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2268
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2269 Enable highlighting ASP-style short tags: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2270
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2271 let php_asp_tags = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2272
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2273 Disable short tags: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2274
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2275 let php_noShortTags = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2276
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2277 For highlighting parent error ] or ): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2278
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2279 let php_parent_error_close = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2280
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2281 For skipping an php end tag, if there exists an open ( or [ without a closing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2282 one: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2283
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2284 let php_parent_error_open = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2285
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2286 Enable folding for classes and functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2287
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2288 let php_folding = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2289
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2290 Selecting syncing method: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2291
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2292 let php_sync_method = x
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2293
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2294 x = -1 to sync by search (default),
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2295 x > 0 to sync at least x lines backwards,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2296 x = 0 to sync from start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2297
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2298
816
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2299 PLAINTEX *plaintex.vim* *ft-plaintex-syntax*
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2300
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2301 TeX is a typesetting language, and plaintex is the file type for the "plain"
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2302 variant of TeX. If you never want your *.tex files recognized as plain TeX,
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2303 see |ft-tex-plugin|.
816
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2304
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2305 This syntax file has the option >
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2306
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2307 let g:plaintex_delimiters = 1
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2308
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2309 if you want to highlight brackets "[]" and braces "{}".
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2310
4a79d6d376f0 updated for version 7.0c02
vimboss
parents: 810
diff changeset
2311
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2312 PPWIZARD *ppwiz.vim* *ft-ppwiz-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2313
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2314 PPWizard is a preprocessor for HTML and OS/2 INF files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2315
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2316 This syntax file has the options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2317
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2318 - ppwiz_highlight_defs : determines highlighting mode for PPWizard's
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2319 definitions. Possible values are
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2320
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2321 ppwiz_highlight_defs = 1 : PPWizard #define statements retain the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2322 colors of their contents (e.g. PPWizard macros and variables)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2323
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2324 ppwiz_highlight_defs = 2 : preprocessor #define and #evaluate
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2325 statements are shown in a single color with the exception of line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2326 continuation symbols
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2327
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2328 The default setting for ppwiz_highlight_defs is 1.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2329
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2330 - ppwiz_with_html : If the value is 1 (the default), highlight literal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2331 HTML code; if 0, treat HTML code like ordinary text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2332
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2333
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2334 PHTML *phtml.vim* *ft-phtml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2335
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2336 There are two options for the phtml syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2337
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2338 If you like SQL syntax highlighting inside Strings, use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2339
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2340 :let phtml_sql_query = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2341
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2342 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2343 set "phtml_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2344
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2345 :let phtml_minlines = 200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2346
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2347
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2348 POSTSCRIPT *postscr.vim* *ft-postscr-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2349
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2350 There are several options when it comes to highlighting PostScript.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2351
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2352 First which version of the PostScript language to highlight. There are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2353 currently three defined language versions, or levels. Level 1 is the original
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2354 and base version, and includes all extensions prior to the release of level 2.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2355 Level 2 is the most common version around, and includes its own set of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2356 extensions prior to the release of level 3. Level 3 is currently the highest
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2357 level supported. You select which level of the PostScript language you want
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2358 highlighted by defining the postscr_level variable as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2359
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2360 :let postscr_level=2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2361
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2362 If this variable is not defined it defaults to 2 (level 2) since this is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2363 the most prevalent version currently.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2364
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2365 Note, not all PS interpreters will support all language features for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2366 particular language level. In particular the %!PS-Adobe-3.0 at the start of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2367 PS files does NOT mean the PostScript present is level 3 PostScript!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2368
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2369 If you are working with Display PostScript, you can include highlighting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2370 Display PS language features by defining the postscr_display variable as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2371 follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2372
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2373 :let postscr_display=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2374
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2375 If you are working with Ghostscript, you can include highlighting of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2376 Ghostscript specific language features by defining the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2377 postscr_ghostscript as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2378
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2379 :let postscr_ghostscript=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2380
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2381 PostScript is a large language, with many predefined elements. While it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2382 useful to have all these elements highlighted, on slower machines this can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2383 cause Vim to slow down. In an attempt to be machine friendly font names and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2384 character encodings are not highlighted by default. Unless you are working
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2385 explicitly with either of these this should be ok. If you want them to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2386 highlighted you should set one or both of the following variables: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2388 :let postscr_fonts=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2389 :let postscr_encodings=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2390
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2391 There is a stylistic option to the highlighting of and, or, and not. In
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2392 PostScript the function of these operators depends on the types of their
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2393 operands - if the operands are booleans then they are the logical operators,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2394 if they are integers then they are binary operators. As binary and logical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2395 operators can be highlighted differently they have to be highlighted one way
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2396 or the other. By default they are treated as logical operators. They can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2397 highlighted as binary operators by defining the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2398 postscr_andornot_binary as follows: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2399
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2400 :let postscr_andornot_binary=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2401 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2402
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2403 *ptcap.vim* *ft-printcap-syntax*
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2404 PRINTCAP + TERMCAP *ft-ptcap-syntax* *ft-termcap-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2405
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2406 This syntax file applies to the printcap and termcap databases.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2407
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2408 In order for Vim to recognize printcap/termcap files that do not match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2409 the patterns *printcap*, or *termcap*, you must put additional patterns
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2410 appropriate to your system in your |myfiletypefile| file. For these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2411 patterns, you must set the variable "b:ptcap_type" to either "print" or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2412 "term", and then the 'filetype' option to ptcap.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2413
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2414 For example, to make Vim identify all files in /etc/termcaps/ as termcap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2415 files, add the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2416
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2417 :au BufNewFile,BufRead /etc/termcaps/* let b:ptcap_type = "term" |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2418 \ set filetype=ptcap
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2419
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2420 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2421 are fixed when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "ptcap_minlines"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2422 internal variable to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2423
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2424 :let ptcap_minlines = 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2425
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2426 (The default is 20 lines.)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2428
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2429 PROGRESS *progress.vim* *ft-progress-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2430
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2431 Files matching "*.w" could be Progress or cweb. If the automatic detection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2432 doesn't work for you, or you don't edit cweb at all, use this in your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2433 startup vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2434 :let filetype_w = "progress"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2435 The same happens for "*.i", which could be assembly, and "*.p", which could be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2436 Pascal. Use this if you don't use assembly and Pascal: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2437 :let filetype_i = "progress"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2438 :let filetype_p = "progress"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2439
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2440
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2441 PYTHON *python.vim* *ft-python-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2442
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2443 There are four options to control Python syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2444
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2445 For highlighted numbers: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2446 :let python_highlight_numbers = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2447
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2448 For highlighted builtin functions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2449 :let python_highlight_builtins = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2450
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2451 For highlighted standard exceptions: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2452 :let python_highlight_exceptions = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2453
2596
fae782ef63dd Runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2581
diff changeset
2454 For highlighted trailing whitespace and mix of spaces and tabs: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2455 :let python_highlight_space_errors = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2456
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2457 If you want all possible Python highlighting (the same as setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2458 preceding three options): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2459 :let python_highlight_all = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2461
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2462 QUAKE *quake.vim* *ft-quake-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2463
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2464 The Quake syntax definition should work for most any FPS (First Person
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2465 Shooter) based on one of the Quake engines. However, the command names vary
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2466 a bit between the three games (Quake, Quake 2, and Quake 3 Arena) so the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2467 syntax definition checks for the existence of three global variables to allow
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2468 users to specify what commands are legal in their files. The three variables
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2469 can be set for the following effects:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2470
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2471 set to highlight commands only available in Quake: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2472 :let quake_is_quake1 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2473
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2474 set to highlight commands only available in Quake 2: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2475 :let quake_is_quake2 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2476
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2477 set to highlight commands only available in Quake 3 Arena: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2478 :let quake_is_quake3 = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2479
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2480 Any combination of these three variables is legal, but might highlight more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2481 commands than are actually available to you by the game.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2482
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2483
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2484 READLINE *readline.vim* *ft-readline-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2485
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2486 The readline library is primarily used by the BASH shell, which adds quite a
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2487 few commands and options to the ones already available. To highlight these
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2488 items as well you can add the following to your |vimrc| or just type it in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2489 command line before loading a file with the readline syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2490 let readline_has_bash = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2492 This will add highlighting for the commands that BASH (version 2.05a and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2493 later, and part earlier) adds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2494
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2495
3920
c53344bacabf Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3713
diff changeset
2496 RESTRUCTURED TEXT *rst.vim* *ft-rst-syntax*
c53344bacabf Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3713
diff changeset
2497
c53344bacabf Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3713
diff changeset
2498 You may set what syntax definitions should be used for code blocks via
c53344bacabf Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3713
diff changeset
2499 let rst_syntax_code_list = ['vim', 'lisp', ...]
c53344bacabf Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3713
diff changeset
2500
c53344bacabf Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3713
diff changeset
2501
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2502 REXX *rexx.vim* *ft-rexx-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2503
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2504 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2505 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "rexx_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2506 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2507 :let rexx_minlines = 50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2508 This will make the syntax synchronization start 50 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2509 displayed line. The default value is 10. The disadvantage of using a larger
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2510 number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2511
2965
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2512 Vim tries to guess what type a ".r" file is. If it can't be detected (from
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2513 comment lines), the default is "r". To make the default rexx add this line to
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2514 your .vimrc: *g:filetype_r*
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2515 >
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2516 :let g:filetype_r = "r"
f2de38a019a2 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2826
diff changeset
2517
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2518
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2519 RUBY *ruby.vim* *ft-ruby-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2520
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2521 There are a number of options to the Ruby syntax highlighting.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2522
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2523 By default, the "end" keyword is colorized according to the opening statement
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2524 of the block it closes. While useful, this feature can be expensive; if you
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2525 experience slow redrawing (or you are on a terminal with poor color support)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2526 you may want to turn it off by defining the "ruby_no_expensive" variable: >
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2527
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2528 :let ruby_no_expensive = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2529 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2530 In this case the same color will be used for all control keywords.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2531
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2532 If you do want this feature enabled, but notice highlighting errors while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2533 scrolling backwards, which are fixed when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2534 the "ruby_minlines" variable to a value larger than 50: >
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2535
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2536 :let ruby_minlines = 100
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2537 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2538 Ideally, this value should be a number of lines large enough to embrace your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2539 largest class or module.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2540
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2541 Highlighting of special identifiers can be disabled by removing the
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2542 rubyIdentifier highlighting: >
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2543
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2544 :hi link rubyIdentifier NONE
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2545 <
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2546 This will prevent highlighting of special identifiers like "ConstantName",
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2547 "$global_var", "@@class_var", "@instance_var", "| block_param |", and
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2548 ":symbol".
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2549
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2550 Significant methods of Kernel, Module and Object are highlighted by default.
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2551 This can be disabled by defining "ruby_no_special_methods": >
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2552
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2553 :let ruby_no_special_methods = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2554 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2555 This will prevent highlighting of important methods such as "require", "attr",
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2556 "private", "raise" and "proc".
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2557
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2558 Ruby operators can be highlighted. This is enabled by defining
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2559 "ruby_operators": >
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2560
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2561 :let ruby_operators = 1
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2562 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2563 Whitespace errors can be highlighted by defining "ruby_space_errors": >
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2564
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2565 :let ruby_space_errors = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2566 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2567 This will highlight trailing whitespace and tabs preceded by a space character
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2568 as errors. This can be refined by defining "ruby_no_trail_space_error" and
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2569 "ruby_no_tab_space_error" which will ignore trailing whitespace and tabs after
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2570 spaces respectively.
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2571
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2572 Folding can be enabled by defining "ruby_fold": >
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2573
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2574 :let ruby_fold = 1
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2575 <
572
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2576 This will set the 'foldmethod' option to "syntax" and allow folding of
2244be18d9e9 updated for version 7.0162
vimboss
parents: 555
diff changeset
2577 classes, modules, methods, code blocks, heredocs and comments.
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2578
1224
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2579 Folding of multiline comments can be disabled by defining
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2580 "ruby_no_comment_fold": >
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2581
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2582 :let ruby_no_comment_fold = 1
edc1c9d6dab9 updated for version 7.1b
vimboss
parents: 1125
diff changeset
2583 <
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2584
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2585 SCHEME *scheme.vim* *ft-scheme-syntax*
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2586
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2587 By default only R5RS keywords are highlighted and properly indented.
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2588
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2589 MzScheme-specific stuff will be used if b:is_mzscheme or g:is_mzscheme
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2590 variables are defined.
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
2591
36
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
2592 Also scheme.vim supports keywords of the Chicken Scheme->C compiler. Define
125e80798a85 updated for version 7.0021
vimboss
parents: 32
diff changeset
2593 b:is_chicken or g:is_chicken, if you need them.
17
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2594
9be87deaeb52 updated for version 7.0009
vimboss
parents: 15
diff changeset
2595
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2596 SDL *sdl.vim* *ft-sdl-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2597
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2598 The SDL highlighting probably misses a few keywords, but SDL has so many
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2599 of them it's almost impossibly to cope.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2600
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2601 The new standard, SDL-2000, specifies that all identifiers are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2602 case-sensitive (which was not so before), and that all keywords can be
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2603 used either completely lowercase or completely uppercase. To have the
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2604 highlighting reflect this, you can set the following variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2605 :let sdl_2000=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2606
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2607 This also sets many new keywords. If you want to disable the old
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2608 keywords, which is probably a good idea, use: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2609 :let SDL_no_96=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2610
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2611
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2612 The indentation is probably also incomplete, but right now I am very
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2613 satisfied with it for my own projects.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2614
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2615
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2616 SED *sed.vim* *ft-sed-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2618 To make tabs stand out from regular blanks (accomplished by using Todo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2619 highlighting on the tabs), define "highlight_sedtabs" by putting >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2620
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2621 :let highlight_sedtabs = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2622
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2623 in the vimrc file. (This special highlighting only applies for tabs
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2624 inside search patterns, replacement texts, addresses or text included
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2625 by an Append/Change/Insert command.) If you enable this option, it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2626 also a good idea to set the tab width to one character; by doing that,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2627 you can easily count the number of tabs in a string.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2628
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2629 Bugs:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2630
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2631 The transform command (y) is treated exactly like the substitute
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2632 command. This means that, as far as this syntax file is concerned,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2633 transform accepts the same flags as substitute, which is wrong.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2634 (Transform accepts no flags.) I tolerate this bug because the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2635 involved commands need very complex treatment (95 patterns, one for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2636 each plausible pattern delimiter).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2637
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2638
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2639 SGML *sgml.vim* *ft-sgml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2640
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2641 The coloring scheme for tags in the SGML file works as follows.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2642
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2643 The <> of opening tags are colored differently than the </> of a closing tag.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2644 This is on purpose! For opening tags the 'Function' color is used, while for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2645 closing tags the 'Type' color is used (See syntax.vim to check how those are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2646 defined for you)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2647
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2648 Known tag names are colored the same way as statements in C. Unknown tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2649 names are not colored which makes it easy to spot errors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2650
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2651 Note that the same is true for argument (or attribute) names. Known attribute
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2652 names are colored differently than unknown ones.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2653
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2654 Some SGML tags are used to change the rendering of text. The following tags
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2655 are recognized by the sgml.vim syntax coloring file and change the way normal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2656 text is shown: <varname> <emphasis> <command> <function> <literal>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2657 <replaceable> <ulink> and <link>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2658
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2659 If you want to change how such text is rendered, you must redefine the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2660 following syntax groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2661
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2662 - sgmlBold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2663 - sgmlBoldItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2664 - sgmlUnderline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2665 - sgmlItalic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2666 - sgmlLink for links
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2667
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2668 To make this redefinition work you must redefine them all and define the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2669 following variable in your vimrc (this is due to the order in which the files
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2670 are read during initialization) >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2671 let sgml_my_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2672
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2673 You can also disable this rendering by adding the following line to your
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2674 vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2675 let sgml_no_rendering=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2676
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2677 (Adapted from the html.vim help text by Claudio Fleiner <claudio@fleiner.com>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2678
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2679
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2680 SH *sh.vim* *ft-sh-syntax* *ft-bash-syntax* *ft-ksh-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2681
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2682 This covers the "normal" Unix (Bourne) sh, bash and the Korn shell.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2683
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2684 Vim attempts to determine which shell type is in use by specifying that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2685 various filenames are of specific types: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2686
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2687 ksh : .kshrc* *.ksh
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2688 bash: .bashrc* bashrc bash.bashrc .bash_profile* *.bash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2689 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2690 If none of these cases pertain, then the first line of the file is examined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2691 (ex. /bin/sh /bin/ksh /bin/bash). If the first line specifies a shelltype,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2692 then that shelltype is used. However some files (ex. .profile) are known to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2693 be shell files but the type is not apparent. Furthermore, on many systems
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2694 sh is symbolically linked to "bash" (Linux, Windows+cygwin) or "ksh" (Posix).
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2695
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2696 One may specify a global default by instantiating one of the following three
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2697 variables in your <.vimrc>:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2698
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2699 ksh: >
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2700 let g:is_kornshell = 1
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2701 < posix: (using this is the same as setting is_kornshell to 1) >
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2702 let g:is_posix = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2703 < bash: >
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2704 let g:is_bash = 1
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2705 < sh: (default) Bourne shell >
828
01583c79d5f4 updated for version 7.0d03
vimboss
parents: 825
diff changeset
2706 let g:is_sh = 1
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2707
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
2708 If there's no "#! ..." line, and the user hasn't availed himself/herself of a
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
2709 default sh.vim syntax setting as just shown, then syntax/sh.vim will assume
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2710 the Bourne shell syntax. No need to quote RFCs or market penetration
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2711 statistics in error reports, please -- just select the default version of the
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2712 sh your system uses in your <.vimrc>.
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2713
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2714 The syntax/sh.vim file provides several levels of syntax-based folding: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2715
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2716 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 0 (default, no syntax folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2717 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 1 (enable function folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2718 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 2 (enable heredoc folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2719 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 4 (enable if/do/for folding)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2720 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2721 then various syntax items (HereDocuments and function bodies) become
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2722 syntax-foldable (see |:syn-fold|). You also may add these together
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2723 to get multiple types of folding: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2724
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2725 let g:sh_fold_enabled= 3 (enables function and heredoc folding)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2726
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2727 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards which are fixed
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2728 when one redraws with CTRL-L, try setting the "sh_minlines" internal variable
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2729 to a larger number. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2730
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2731 let sh_minlines = 500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2732
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2733 This will make syntax synchronization start 500 lines before the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2734 displayed line. The default value is 200. The disadvantage of using a larger
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2735 number is that redrawing can become slow.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2736
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2737 If you don't have much to synchronize on, displaying can be very slow. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2738 reduce this, the "sh_maxlines" internal variable can be set. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2739
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2740 let sh_maxlines = 100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2741 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2742 The default is to use the twice sh_minlines. Set it to a smaller number to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2743 speed up displaying. The disadvantage is that highlight errors may appear.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2744
3099
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2745 *g:sh_isk* *g:sh_noisk*
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2746 The shell languages appear to let "." be part of words, commands, etc;
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2747 consequently it should be in the isk for sh.vim. As of v116 of syntax/sh.vim,
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2748 syntax/sh.vim will append the "." to |'iskeyword'| by default; you may control
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2749 this behavior with: >
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2750 let g:sh_isk = '..whatever characters you want as part of iskeyword'
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2751 let g:sh_noisk= 1 " otherwise, if this exists, the isk will NOT chg
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2752 <
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2753 *sh-embed* *sh-awk*
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2754 Sh: EMBEDDING LANGUAGES~
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2755
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2756 You may wish to embed languages into sh. I'll give an example courtesy of
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2757 Lorance Stinson on how to do this with awk as an example. Put the following
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2758 file into $HOME/.vim/after/syntax/sh/awkembed.vim: >
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2759
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2760 " AWK Embedding: {{{1
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2761 " ==============
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2762 " Shamelessly ripped from aspperl.vim by Aaron Hope.
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2763 if exists("b:current_syntax")
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2764 unlet b:current_syntax
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2765 endif
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2766 syn include @AWKScript syntax/awk.vim
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2767 syn region AWKScriptCode matchgroup=AWKCommand start=+[=\\]\@<!'+ skip=+\\'+ end=+'+ contains=@AWKScript contained
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2768 syn region AWKScriptEmbedded matchgroup=AWKCommand start=+\<awk\>+ skip=+\\$+ end=+[=\\]\@<!'+me=e-1 contains=@shIdList,@shExprList2 nextgroup=AWKScriptCode
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2769 syn cluster shCommandSubList add=AWKScriptEmbedded
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2770 hi def link AWKCommand Type
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2771 <
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2772 This code will then let the awk code in the single quotes: >
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2773 awk '...awk code here...'
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2774 be highlighted using the awk highlighting syntax. Clearly this may be
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2775 extended to other languages.
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2776
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2777
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2778 SPEEDUP *spup.vim* *ft-spup-syntax*
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2779 (AspenTech plant simulator)
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2780
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2781 The Speedup syntax file has some options:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2782
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2783 - strict_subsections : If this variable is defined, only keywords for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2784 sections and subsections will be highlighted as statements but not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2785 other keywords (like WITHIN in the OPERATION section).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2786
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2787 - highlight_types : Definition of this variable causes stream types
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2788 like temperature or pressure to be highlighted as Type, not as a
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2789 plain Identifier. Included are the types that are usually found in
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2790 the DECLARE section; if you defined own types, you have to include
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2791 them in the syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2792
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2793 - oneline_comments : this value ranges from 1 to 3 and determines the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2794 highlighting of # style comments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2795
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2796 oneline_comments = 1 : allow normal Speedup code after an even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2797 number of #s.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2798
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2799 oneline_comments = 2 : show code starting with the second # as
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2800 error. This is the default setting.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2801
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2802 oneline_comments = 3 : show the whole line as error if it contains
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2803 more than one #.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2804
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2805 Since especially OPERATION sections tend to become very large due to
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2806 PRESETting variables, syncing may be critical. If your computer is
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2807 fast enough, you can increase minlines and/or maxlines near the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2808 the syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2809
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2810
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2811 SQL *sql.vim* *ft-sql-syntax*
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2812 *sqlinformix.vim* *ft-sqlinformix-syntax*
720
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2813 *sqlanywhere.vim* *ft-sqlanywhere-syntax*
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2814
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2815 While there is an ANSI standard for SQL, most database engines add their own
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2816 custom extensions. Vim currently supports the Oracle and Informix dialects of
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2817 SQL. Vim assumes "*.sql" files are Oracle SQL by default.
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2818
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2819 Vim currently has SQL support for a variety of different vendors via syntax
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2820 scripts. You can change Vim's default from Oracle to any of the current SQL
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2821 supported types. You can also easily alter the SQL dialect being used on a
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2822 buffer by buffer basis.
e180933b876a updated for version 7.0219
vimboss
parents: 699
diff changeset
2823
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2824 For more detailed instructions see |ft_sql.txt|.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2825
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
2826
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2827 TCSH *tcsh.vim* *ft-tcsh-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2828
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2829 This covers the shell named "tcsh". It is a superset of csh. See |csh.vim|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2830 for how the filetype is detected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2831
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2832 Tcsh does not allow \" in strings unless the "backslash_quote" shell variable
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2833 is set. If you want VIM to assume that no backslash quote constructs exist add
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2834 this line to your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2835
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2836 :let tcsh_backslash_quote = 0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2837
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2838 If you notice highlighting errors while scrolling backwards, which are fixed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2839 when redrawing with CTRL-L, try setting the "tcsh_minlines" internal variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2840 to a larger number: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2841
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2842 :let tcsh_minlines = 1000
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2843
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2844 This will make the syntax synchronization start 1000 lines before the first
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2845 displayed line. If you set "tcsh_minlines" to "fromstart", then
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2846 synchronization is done from the start of the file. The default value for
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2847 tcsh_minlines is 100. The disadvantage of using a larger number is that
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
2848 redrawing can become slow.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2849
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2850
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
2851 TEX *tex.vim* *ft-tex-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2852
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2853 *tex-folding*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2854 Tex: Want Syntax Folding? ~
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2855
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2856 As of version 28 of <syntax/tex.vim>, syntax-based folding of parts, chapters,
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2857 sections, subsections, etc are supported. Put >
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2858 let g:tex_fold_enabled=1
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2859 in your <.vimrc>, and :set fdm=syntax. I suggest doing the latter via a
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2860 modeline at the end of your LaTeX file: >
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2861 % vim: fdm=syntax
3099
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2862 If your system becomes too slow, then you might wish to look into >
3153
37ecb8ff4560 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3099
diff changeset
2863 http://vim.wikia.com/wiki/Keep_folds_closed_while_inserting_text
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2864 <
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2865 *tex-nospell*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2866 Tex: Don't Want Spell Checking In Comments? ~
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2867
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2868 Some folks like to include things like source code in comments and so would
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2869 prefer that spell checking be disabled in comments in LaTeX files. To do
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2870 this, put the following in your <.vimrc>: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2871 let g:tex_comment_nospell= 1
3492
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2872 The comment lines >
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2873 % nospell{
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2874 ...
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2875 % nospell}
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2876 will suppress spell checking between them. These comment lines spelling
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2877 control are known to be fragile; for example, don't include any of the section
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2878 commands (\part, \chapter, \section, \paragraph, etc) inside nospell blocks
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2879 or interleave environments (such as math) across nospell blocks.
2494
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2880 *tex-verb*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2881 Tex: Want Spell Checking in Verbatim Zones?~
2494
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2882
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2883 Often verbatim regions are used for things like source code; seldom does
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2884 one want source code spell-checked. However, for those of you who do
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2885 want your verbatim zones spell-checked, put the following in your <.vimrc>: >
ed997d0ceb26 Updated syntax files. (Charles Campbell)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2490
diff changeset
2886 let g:tex_verbspell= 1
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2887 <
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2888 *tex-runon*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2889 Tex: Run-on Comments or MathZones ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2890
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2891 The <syntax/tex.vim> highlighting supports TeX, LaTeX, and some AmsTeX. The
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2892 highlighting supports three primary zones/regions: normal, texZone, and
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2893 texMathZone. Although considerable effort has been made to have these zones
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2894 terminate properly, zones delineated by $..$ and $$..$$ cannot be synchronized
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2895 as there's no difference between start and end patterns. Consequently, a
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2896 special "TeX comment" has been provided >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2897 %stopzone
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2898 which will forcibly terminate the highlighting of either a texZone or a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2899 texMathZone.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2900
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2901 *tex-slow*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2902 Tex: Slow Syntax Highlighting? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2903
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2904 If you have a slow computer, you may wish to reduce the values for >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2905 :syn sync maxlines=200
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2906 :syn sync minlines=50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2907 (especially the latter). If your computer is fast, you may wish to
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
2908 increase them. This primarily affects synchronizing (i.e. just what group,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2909 if any, is the text at the top of the screen supposed to be in?).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2910
3099
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2911 Another cause of slow highlighting is due to syntax-driven folding; see
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2912 |tex-folding| for a way around this.
887d6d91882e Updated a few runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2965
diff changeset
2913
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2914 *tex-morecommands* *tex-package*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2915 Tex: Want To Highlight More Commands? ~
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2916
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2917 LaTeX is a programmable language, and so there are thousands of packages full
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2918 of specialized LaTeX commands, syntax, and fonts. If you're using such a
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2919 package you'll often wish that the distributed syntax/tex.vim would support
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2920 it. However, clearly this is impractical. So please consider using the
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2921 techniques in |mysyntaxfile-add| to extend or modify the highlighting provided
3237
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3224
diff changeset
2922 by syntax/tex.vim. Please consider uploading any extensions that you write,
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3224
diff changeset
2923 which typically would go in $HOME/after/syntax/tex/[pkgname].vim, to
91e53bcb7946 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3224
diff changeset
2924 http://vim.sf.net/.
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
2925
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2926 *tex-error*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2927 Tex: Excessive Error Highlighting? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2928
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2929 The <tex.vim> supports lexical error checking of various sorts. Thus,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2930 although the error checking is ofttimes very useful, it can indicate
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2931 errors where none actually are. If this proves to be a problem for you,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2932 you may put in your <.vimrc> the following statement: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2933 let tex_no_error=1
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2934 and all error checking by <syntax/tex.vim> will be suppressed.
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2935
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2936 *tex-math*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2937 Tex: Need a new Math Group? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2938
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2939 If you want to include a new math group in your LaTeX, the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2940 code shows you an example as to how you might do so: >
477
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2941 call TexNewMathZone(sfx,mathzone,starform)
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2942 You'll want to provide the new math group with a unique suffix
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2943 (currently, A-L and V-Z are taken by <syntax/tex.vim> itself).
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2944 As an example, consider how eqnarray is set up by <syntax/tex.vim>: >
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2945 call TexNewMathZone("D","eqnarray",1)
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2946 You'll need to change "mathzone" to the name of your new math group,
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2947 and then to the call to it in .vim/after/syntax/tex.vim.
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2948 The "starform" variable, if true, implies that your new math group
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2949 has a starred form (ie. eqnarray*).
f8b75b8f1988 updated for version 7.0128
vimboss
parents: 449
diff changeset
2950
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
2951 *tex-style*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2952 Tex: Starting a New Style? ~
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2953
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2954 One may use "\makeatletter" in *.tex files, thereby making the use of "@" in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2955 commands available. However, since the *.tex file doesn't have one of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2956 following suffices: sty cls clo dtx ltx, the syntax highlighting will flag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2957 such use of @ as an error. To solve this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2958
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2959 :let b:tex_stylish = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2960 :set ft=tex
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2962 Putting "let g:tex_stylish=1" into your <.vimrc> will make <syntax/tex.vim>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2963 always accept such use of @.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
2964
2417
acfb7eddf13c Update TeX syntax file.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
2965 *tex-cchar* *tex-cole* *tex-conceal*
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2966 Tex: Taking Advantage of Conceal Mode~
2417
acfb7eddf13c Update TeX syntax file.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
2967
2426
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2968 If you have |'conceallevel'| set to 2 and if your encoding is utf-8, then a
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2969 number of character sequences can be translated into appropriate utf-8 glyphs,
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2970 including various accented characters, Greek characters in MathZones, and
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2971 superscripts and subscripts in MathZones. Not all characters can be made into
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2972 superscripts or subscripts; the constraint is due to what utf-8 supports.
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2973 In fact, only a few characters are supported as subscripts.
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2974
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2975 One way to use this is to have vertically split windows (see |CTRL-W_v|); one
e52d87a2bb3e More runtime file updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2417
diff changeset
2976 with |'conceallevel'| at 0 and the other at 2; and both using |'scrollbind'|.
2417
acfb7eddf13c Update TeX syntax file.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2413
diff changeset
2977
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2978 *g:tex_conceal*
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2979 Tex: Selective Conceal Mode~
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2980
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2981 You may selectively use conceal mode by setting g:tex_conceal in your
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2982 <.vimrc>. By default it is set to "admgs" to enable conceal for the
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2983 following sets of characters: >
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2984
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2985 a = accents/ligatures
3492
3482d151136b Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3465
diff changeset
2986 b = bold and italic
2535
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2987 d = delimiters
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2988 m = math symbols
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2989 g = Greek
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2990 s = superscripts/subscripts
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2991 <
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2992 By leaving one or more of these out, the associated conceal-character
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2993 substitution will not be made.
31e51111bd14 Runtime file updates. Fix tar plugin window split.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2527
diff changeset
2994
3456
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
2995 *g:tex_isk*
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
2996 Tex: Controlling What's In A Keyword~
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
2997
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
2998 (La)Tex keywords normally use the characters 0-9,a-z,A-Z,192-255 only
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
2999 but the "_" is the only one that causes problems. So, by default,
3465
161d01cbb165 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3456
diff changeset
3000 syntax/tex.vim overrides the usual |'iskeyword'| setting (using |:setlocal|)
3456
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
3001 with one that works for LaTeX.
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
3002
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
3003 However, one may override this iskeyword re-setting by setting the
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
3004 variable, g:tex_isk, in one's .vimrc to whatever one wishes and
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
3005 it will be used instead.
4dde9b516e72 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3445
diff changeset
3006
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3007
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
3008 TF *tf.vim* *ft-tf-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3009
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3010 There is one option for the tf syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3011
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3012 For syncing, minlines defaults to 100. If you prefer another value, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3013 set "tf_minlines" to the value you desire. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3014
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3015 :let tf_minlines = your choice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3016
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3017
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3018 VIM *vim.vim* *ft-vim-syntax*
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3019 *g:vimsyn_minlines* *g:vimsyn_maxlines*
2283
7e1bd501306d Mainly documentation updates.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2269
diff changeset
3020 There is a trade-off between more accurate syntax highlighting versus screen
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3021 updating speed. To improve accuracy, you may wish to increase the
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3022 g:vimsyn_minlines variable. The g:vimsyn_maxlines variable may be used to
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3023 improve screen updating rates (see |:syn-sync| for more on this). >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3024
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3025 g:vimsyn_minlines : used to set synchronization minlines
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3026 g:vimsyn_maxlines : used to set synchronization maxlines
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3027 <
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3028 (g:vim_minlines and g:vim_maxlines are deprecated variants of
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3029 these two options)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3030
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3031 *g:vimsyn_embed*
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3032 The g:vimsyn_embed option allows users to select what, if any, types of
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3033 embedded script highlighting they wish to have. >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3034
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3035 g:vimsyn_embed == 0 : don't embed any scripts
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3036 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'm' : embed mzscheme (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3037 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'p' : embed perl (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3038 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'P' : embed python (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3039 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 'r' : embed ruby (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3040 g:vimsyn_embed =~ 't' : embed tcl (but only if vim supports it)
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3041 <
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3042 By default, g:vimsyn_embed is "mpPr"; ie. syntax/vim.vim will support
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3043 highlighting mzscheme, perl, python, and ruby by default. Vim's has("tcl")
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3044 test appears to hang vim when tcl is not truly available. Thus, by default,
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3045 tcl is not supported for embedding (but those of you who like tcl embedded in
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3046 their vim syntax highlighting can simply include it in the g:vimembedscript
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3047 option).
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3048 *g:vimsyn_folding*
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3049
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3050 Some folding is now supported with syntax/vim.vim: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3051
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3052 g:vimsyn_folding == 0 or doesn't exist: no syntax-based folding
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3053 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'a' : augroups
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3054 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'f' : fold functions
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3055 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'm' : fold mzscheme script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3056 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'p' : fold perl script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3057 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'P' : fold python script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3058 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 'r' : fold ruby script
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3059 g:vimsyn_folding =~ 't' : fold tcl script
3682
11d40fc82f11 Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3492
diff changeset
3060 <
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3061 *g:vimsyn_noerror*
846
db44f7b81373 updated for version 7.0f03
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
3062 Not all error highlighting that syntax/vim.vim does may be correct; VimL is a
db44f7b81373 updated for version 7.0f03
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
3063 difficult language to highlight correctly. A way to suppress error
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3064 highlighting is to put the following line in your |vimrc|: >
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3065
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3066 let g:vimsyn_noerror = 1
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3067 <
846
db44f7b81373 updated for version 7.0f03
vimboss
parents: 844
diff changeset
3068
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3069
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
3070 XF86CONFIG *xf86conf.vim* *ft-xf86conf-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3071
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3072 The syntax of XF86Config file differs in XFree86 v3.x and v4.x. Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3073 variants are supported. Automatic detection is used, but is far from perfect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3074 You may need to specify the version manually. Set the variable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3075 xf86conf_xfree86_version to 3 or 4 according to your XFree86 version in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3076 your .vimrc. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3077 :let xf86conf_xfree86_version=3
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3078 When using a mix of versions, set the b:xf86conf_xfree86_version variable.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3079
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3080 Note that spaces and underscores in option names are not supported. Use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3081 "SyncOnGreen" instead of "__s yn con gr_e_e_n" if you want the option name
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3082 highlighted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3083
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3084
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
3085 XML *xml.vim* *ft-xml-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3086
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
3087 Xml namespaces are highlighted by default. This can be inhibited by
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3088 setting a global variable: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3089
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3090 :let g:xml_namespace_transparent=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3091 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3092 *xml-folding*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3093 The xml syntax file provides syntax |folding| (see |:syn-fold|) between
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
3094 start and end tags. This can be turned on by >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3095
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3096 :let g:xml_syntax_folding = 1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3097 :set foldmethod=syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3098
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3099 Note: syntax folding might slow down syntax highlighting significantly,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3100 especially for large files.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3101
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3102
501
ce2181d14aa0 updated for version 7.0139
vimboss
parents: 484
diff changeset
3103 X Pixmaps (XPM) *xpm.vim* *ft-xpm-syntax*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3104
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3105 xpm.vim creates its syntax items dynamically based upon the contents of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3106 XPM file. Thus if you make changes e.g. in the color specification strings,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3107 you have to source it again e.g. with ":set syn=xpm".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3108
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3109 To copy a pixel with one of the colors, yank a "pixel" with "yl" and insert it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3110 somewhere else with "P".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3111
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3112 Do you want to draw with the mouse? Try the following: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3113 :function! GetPixel()
823
9ab23f1e137f updated for version 7.0c12
vimboss
parents: 819
diff changeset
3114 : let c = getline(".")[col(".") - 1]
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3115 : echo c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3116 : exe "noremap <LeftMouse> <LeftMouse>r".c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3117 : exe "noremap <LeftDrag> <LeftMouse>r".c
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3118 :endfunction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3119 :noremap <RightMouse> <LeftMouse>:call GetPixel()<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3120 :set guicursor=n:hor20 " to see the color beneath the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3121 This turns the right button into a pipette and the left button into a pen.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3122 It will work with XPM files that have one character per pixel only and you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3123 must not click outside of the pixel strings, but feel free to improve it.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3124
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3125 It will look much better with a font in a quadratic cell size, e.g. for X: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3126 :set guifont=-*-clean-medium-r-*-*-8-*-*-*-*-80-*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3127
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3128 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3129 5. Defining a syntax *:syn-define* *E410*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3130
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3131 Vim understands three types of syntax items:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3132
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3133 1. Keyword
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3134 It can only contain keyword characters, according to the 'iskeyword'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3135 option. It cannot contain other syntax items. It will only match with a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3136 complete word (there are no keyword characters before or after the match).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3137 The keyword "if" would match in "if(a=b)", but not in "ifdef x", because
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3138 "(" is not a keyword character and "d" is.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3139
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3140 2. Match
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3141 This is a match with a single regexp pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3142
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3143 3. Region
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3144 This starts at a match of the "start" regexp pattern and ends with a match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3145 with the "end" regexp pattern. Any other text can appear in between. A
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3146 "skip" regexp pattern can be used to avoid matching the "end" pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3147
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3148 Several syntax ITEMs can be put into one syntax GROUP. For a syntax group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3149 you can give highlighting attributes. For example, you could have an item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3150 to define a "/* .. */" comment and another one that defines a "// .." comment,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3151 and put them both in the "Comment" group. You can then specify that a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3152 "Comment" will be in bold font and have a blue color. You are free to make
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3153 one highlight group for one syntax item, or put all items into one group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3154 This depends on how you want to specify your highlighting attributes. Putting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3155 each item in its own group results in having to specify the highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3156 for a lot of groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3157
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3158 Note that a syntax group and a highlight group are similar. For a highlight
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3159 group you will have given highlight attributes. These attributes will be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3160 for the syntax group with the same name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3161
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3162 In case more than one item matches at the same position, the one that was
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3163 defined LAST wins. Thus you can override previously defined syntax items by
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3164 using an item that matches the same text. But a keyword always goes before a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3165 match or region. And a keyword with matching case always goes before a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3166 keyword with ignoring case.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3168
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3169 PRIORITY *:syn-priority*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3170
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3171 When several syntax items may match, these rules are used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3172
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3173 1. When multiple Match or Region items start in the same position, the item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3174 defined last has priority.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3175 2. A Keyword has priority over Match and Region items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3176 3. An item that starts in an earlier position has priority over items that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3177 start in later positions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3178
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3179
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3180 DEFINING CASE *:syn-case* *E390*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3181
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3182 :sy[ntax] case [match | ignore]
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3183 This defines if the following ":syntax" commands will work with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3184 matching case, when using "match", or with ignoring case, when using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3185 "ignore". Note that any items before this are not affected, and all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3186 items until the next ":syntax case" command are affected.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3187
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3188
419
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3189 SPELL CHECKING *:syn-spell*
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3190
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3191 :sy[ntax] spell [toplevel | notoplevel | default]
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3192 This defines where spell checking is to be done for text that is not
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3193 in a syntax item:
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3194
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3195 toplevel: Text is spell checked.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3196 notoplevel: Text is not spell checked.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3197 default: When there is a @Spell cluster no spell checking.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3198
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3199 For text in syntax items use the @Spell and @NoSpell clusters
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3200 |spell-syntax|. When there is no @Spell and no @NoSpell cluster then
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3201 spell checking is done for "default" and "toplevel".
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3202
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3203 To activate spell checking the 'spell' option must be set.
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3204
f713fc55bf7b updated for version 7.0109
vimboss
parents: 391
diff changeset
3205
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3206 DEFINING KEYWORDS *:syn-keyword*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3207
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3208 :sy[ntax] keyword {group-name} [{options}] {keyword} .. [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3209
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3210 This defines a number of keywords.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3211
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3212 {group-name} Is a syntax group name such as "Comment".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3213 [{options}] See |:syn-arguments| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3214 {keyword} .. Is a list of keywords which are part of this group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3215
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3216 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3217 :syntax keyword Type int long char
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3218 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3219 The {options} can be given anywhere in the line. They will apply to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3220 all keywords given, also for options that come after a keyword.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3221 These examples do exactly the same: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3222 :syntax keyword Type contained int long char
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3223 :syntax keyword Type int long contained char
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3224 :syntax keyword Type int long char contained
838
8e5830943bff updated for version 7.0e04
vimboss
parents: 834
diff changeset
3225 < *E789*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3226 When you have a keyword with an optional tail, like Ex commands in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3227 Vim, you can put the optional characters inside [], to define all the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3228 variations at once: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3229 :syntax keyword vimCommand ab[breviate] n[ext]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3230 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3231 Don't forget that a keyword can only be recognized if all the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3232 characters are included in the 'iskeyword' option. If one character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3233 isn't, the keyword will never be recognized.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3234 Multi-byte characters can also be used. These do not have to be in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3235 'iskeyword'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3237 A keyword always has higher priority than a match or region, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3238 keyword is used if more than one item matches. Keywords do not nest
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3239 and a keyword can't contain anything else.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3240
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3241 Note that when you have a keyword that is the same as an option (even
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3242 one that isn't allowed here), you can not use it. Use a match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3243 instead.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3244
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3245 The maximum length of a keyword is 80 characters.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3246
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3247 The same keyword can be defined multiple times, when its containment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3248 differs. For example, you can define the keyword once not contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3249 and use one highlight group, and once contained, and use a different
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
3250 highlight group. Example: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3251 :syn keyword vimCommand tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3252 :syn keyword vimSetting contained tag
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3253 < When finding "tag" outside of any syntax item, the "vimCommand"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3254 highlight group is used. When finding "tag" in a syntax item that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3255 contains "vimSetting", the "vimSetting" group is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3256
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3257
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3258 DEFINING MATCHES *:syn-match*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3259
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3260 :sy[ntax] match {group-name} [{options}] [excludenl] {pattern} [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3261
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3262 This defines one match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3263
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3264 {group-name} A syntax group name such as "Comment".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3265 [{options}] See |:syn-arguments| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3266 [excludenl] Don't make a pattern with the end-of-line "$"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3267 extend a containing match or region. Must be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3268 given before the pattern. |:syn-excludenl|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3269 {pattern} The search pattern that defines the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3270 See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3271 Note that the pattern may match more than one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3272 line, which makes the match depend on where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3273 Vim starts searching for the pattern. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3274 need to make sure syncing takes care of this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3275
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3276 Example (match a character constant): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3277 :syntax match Character /'.'/hs=s+1,he=e-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3278 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3279
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3280 DEFINING REGIONS *:syn-region* *:syn-start* *:syn-skip* *:syn-end*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3281 *E398* *E399*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3282 :sy[ntax] region {group-name} [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3283 [matchgroup={group-name}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3284 [keepend]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3285 [extend]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3286 [excludenl]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3287 start={start_pattern} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3288 [skip={skip_pattern}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3289 end={end_pattern} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3290 [{options}]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3291
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3292 This defines one region. It may span several lines.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3293
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3294 {group-name} A syntax group name such as "Comment".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3295 [{options}] See |:syn-arguments| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3296 [matchgroup={group-name}] The syntax group to use for the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3297 start or end pattern matches only. Not used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3298 for the text in between the matched start and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3299 end patterns. Use NONE to reset to not using
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3300 a different group for the start or end match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3301 See |:syn-matchgroup|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3302 keepend Don't allow contained matches to go past a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3303 match with the end pattern. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3304 |:syn-keepend|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3305 extend Override a "keepend" for an item this region
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
3306 is contained in. See |:syn-extend|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3307 excludenl Don't make a pattern with the end-of-line "$"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3308 extend a containing match or item. Only
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3309 useful for end patterns. Must be given before
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3310 the patterns it applies to. |:syn-excludenl|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3311 start={start_pattern} The search pattern that defines the start of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3312 the region. See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3313 skip={skip_pattern} The search pattern that defines text inside
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3314 the region where not to look for the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3315 pattern. See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3316 end={end_pattern} The search pattern that defines the end of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3317 the region. See |:syn-pattern| below.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3318
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3319 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3320 :syntax region String start=+"+ skip=+\\"+ end=+"+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3321 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3322 The start/skip/end patterns and the options can be given in any order.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3323 There can be zero or one skip pattern. There must be one or more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3324 start and end patterns. This means that you can omit the skip
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3325 pattern, but you must give at least one start and one end pattern. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3326 is allowed to have white space before and after the equal sign
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3327 (although it mostly looks better without white space).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3328
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3329 When more than one start pattern is given, a match with one of these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3330 is sufficient. This means there is an OR relation between the start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3331 patterns. The last one that matches is used. The same is true for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3332 the end patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3333
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3334 The search for the end pattern starts right after the start pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3335 Offsets are not used for this. This implies that the match for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3336 end pattern will never overlap with the start pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3337
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3338 The skip and end pattern can match across line breaks, but since the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3339 search for the pattern can start in any line it often does not do what
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3340 you want. The skip pattern doesn't avoid a match of an end pattern in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3341 the next line. Use single-line patterns to avoid trouble.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3342
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3343 Note: The decision to start a region is only based on a matching start
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3344 pattern. There is no check for a matching end pattern. This does NOT
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3345 work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3346 :syn region First start="(" end=":"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3347 :syn region Second start="(" end=";"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3348 < The Second always matches before the First (last defined pattern has
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3349 higher priority). The Second region then continues until the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3350 ';', no matter if there is a ':' before it. Using a match does work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3351 :syn match First "(\_.\{-}:"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3352 :syn match Second "(\_.\{-};"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3353 < This pattern matches any character or line break with "\_." and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3354 repeats that with "\{-}" (repeat as few as possible).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3355
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3356 *:syn-keepend*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3357 By default, a contained match can obscure a match for the end pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3358 This is useful for nesting. For example, a region that starts with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3359 "{" and ends with "}", can contain another region. An encountered "}"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3360 will then end the contained region, but not the outer region:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3361 { starts outer "{}" region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3362 { starts contained "{}" region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3363 } ends contained "{}" region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3364 } ends outer "{} region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3365 If you don't want this, the "keepend" argument will make the matching
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3366 of an end pattern of the outer region also end any contained item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3367 This makes it impossible to nest the same region, but allows for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3368 contained items to highlight parts of the end pattern, without causing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3369 that to skip the match with the end pattern. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3370 :syn match vimComment +"[^"]\+$+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3371 :syn region vimCommand start="set" end="$" contains=vimComment keepend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3372 < The "keepend" makes the vimCommand always end at the end of the line,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3373 even though the contained vimComment includes a match with the <EOL>.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3374
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3375 When "keepend" is not used, a match with an end pattern is retried
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3376 after each contained match. When "keepend" is included, the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3377 encountered match with an end pattern is used, truncating any
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3378 contained matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3379 *:syn-extend*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3380 The "keepend" behavior can be changed by using the "extend" argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3381 When an item with "extend" is contained in an item that uses
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3382 "keepend", the "keepend" is ignored and the containing region will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3383 extended.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3384 This can be used to have some contained items extend a region while
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3385 others don't. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3386
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3387 :syn region htmlRef start=+<a>+ end=+</a>+ keepend contains=htmlItem,htmlScript
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3388 :syn match htmlItem +<[^>]*>+ contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3389 :syn region htmlScript start=+<script+ end=+</script[^>]*>+ contained extend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3390
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3391 < Here the htmlItem item does not make the htmlRef item continue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3392 further, it is only used to highlight the <> items. The htmlScript
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3393 item does extend the htmlRef item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3394
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3395 Another example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3396 :syn region xmlFold start="<a>" end="</a>" fold transparent keepend extend
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3397 < This defines a region with "keepend", so that its end cannot be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3398 changed by contained items, like when the "</a>" is matched to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3399 highlight it differently. But when the xmlFold region is nested (it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3400 includes itself), the "extend" applies, so that the "</a>" of a nested
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3401 region only ends that region, and not the one it is contained in.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3402
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3403 *:syn-excludenl*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3404 When a pattern for a match or end pattern of a region includes a '$'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3405 to match the end-of-line, it will make a region item that it is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3406 contained in continue on the next line. For example, a match with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3407 "\\$" (backslash at the end of the line) can make a region continue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3408 that would normally stop at the end of the line. This is the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3409 behavior. If this is not wanted, there are two ways to avoid it:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3410 1. Use "keepend" for the containing item. This will keep all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3411 contained matches from extending the match or region. It can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3412 used when all contained items must not extend the containing item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3413 2. Use "excludenl" in the contained item. This will keep that match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3414 from extending the containing match or region. It can be used if
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3415 only some contained items must not extend the containing item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3416 "excludenl" must be given before the pattern it applies to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3417
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3418 *:syn-matchgroup*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3419 "matchgroup" can be used to highlight the start and/or end pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3420 differently than the body of the region. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3421 :syntax region String matchgroup=Quote start=+"+ skip=+\\"+ end=+"+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3422 < This will highlight the quotes with the "Quote" group, and the text in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3423 between with the "String" group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3424 The "matchgroup" is used for all start and end patterns that follow,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3425 until the next "matchgroup". Use "matchgroup=NONE" to go back to not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3426 using a matchgroup.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3427
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3428 In a start or end pattern that is highlighted with "matchgroup" the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3429 contained items of the region are not used. This can be used to avoid
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3430 that a contained item matches in the start or end pattern match. When
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3431 using "transparent", this does not apply to a start or end pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3432 match that is highlighted with "matchgroup".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3433
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3434 Here is an example, which highlights three levels of parentheses in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3435 different colors: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3436 :sy region par1 matchgroup=par1 start=/(/ end=/)/ contains=par2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3437 :sy region par2 matchgroup=par2 start=/(/ end=/)/ contains=par3 contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3438 :sy region par3 matchgroup=par3 start=/(/ end=/)/ contains=par1 contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3439 :hi par1 ctermfg=red guifg=red
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3440 :hi par2 ctermfg=blue guifg=blue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3441 :hi par3 ctermfg=darkgreen guifg=darkgreen
2751
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3442 <
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3443 *E849*
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3444 The maximum number of syntax groups is 19999.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3446 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3447 6. :syntax arguments *:syn-arguments*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3448
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3449 The :syntax commands that define syntax items take a number of arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3450 The common ones are explained here. The arguments may be given in any order
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3451 and may be mixed with patterns.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3452
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3453 Not all commands accept all arguments. This table shows which arguments
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3454 can not be used for all commands:
2520
6768ebd0bc04 Remove unused code.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2496
diff changeset
3455 *E395*
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3456 contains oneline fold display extend concealends~
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3457 :syntax keyword - - - - - -
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3458 :syntax match yes - yes yes yes -
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3459 :syntax region yes yes yes yes yes yes
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3460
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3461 These arguments can be used for all three commands:
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3462 conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3463 cchar
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3464 contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3465 containedin
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3466 nextgroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3467 transparent
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3468 skipwhite
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3469 skipnl
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3470 skipempty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3471
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3472 conceal *conceal* *:syn-conceal*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3473
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3474 When the "conceal" argument is given, the item is marked as concealable.
2269
fb627e94e6c6 Couple of small fixes for conceal feature. (Dominique Pelle)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2254
diff changeset
3475 Whether or not it is actually concealed depends on the value of the
2378
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2370
diff changeset
3476 'conceallevel' option. The 'concealcursor' option is used to decide whether
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2370
diff changeset
3477 concealable items in the current line are displayed unconcealed to be able to
85b7dc8da5eb Add the 'concealcursor' option to decide when the cursor line is to be
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2370
diff changeset
3478 edit the line.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3479
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3480 concealends *:syn-concealends*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3481
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3482 When the "concealends" argument is given, the start and end matches of
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3483 the region, but not the contents of the region, are marked as concealable.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3484 Whether or not they are actually concealed depends on the setting on the
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3485 'conceallevel' option. The ends of a region can only be concealed separately
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3486 in this way when they have their own highlighting via "matchgroup"
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3487
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3488 cchar *:syn-cchar*
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
3489 *E844*
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3490 The "cchar" argument defines the character shown in place of the item
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3491 when it is concealed (setting "cchar" only makes sense when the conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3492 argument is given.) If "cchar" is not set then the default conceal
2698
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
3493 character defined in the 'listchars' option is used. The character cannot be
b6471224d2af Updated runtime files and translations.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2681
diff changeset
3494 a control character such as Tab. Example: >
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3495 :syntax match Entity "&amp;" conceal cchar=&
2296
eb7be7b075a6 Support :browse for commands that use an error file argument. (Lech Lorens)
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2283
diff changeset
3496 See |hl-Conceal| for highlighting.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3497
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3498 contained *:syn-contained*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3499
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3500 When the "contained" argument is given, this item will not be recognized at
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3501 the top level, but only when it is mentioned in the "contains" field of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3502 another match. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3503 :syntax keyword Todo TODO contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3504 :syntax match Comment "//.*" contains=Todo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3505
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3506
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3507 display *:syn-display*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3509 If the "display" argument is given, this item will be skipped when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3510 detected highlighting will not be displayed. This will speed up highlighting,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3511 by skipping this item when only finding the syntax state for the text that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3512 to be displayed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3513
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3514 Generally, you can use "display" for match and region items that meet these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3515 conditions:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3516 - The item does not continue past the end of a line. Example for C: A region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3517 for a "/*" comment can't contain "display", because it continues on the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3518 line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3519 - The item does not contain items that continue past the end of the line or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3520 make it continue on the next line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3521 - The item does not change the size of any item it is contained in. Example
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3522 for C: A match with "\\$" in a preprocessor match can't have "display",
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3523 because it may make that preprocessor match shorter.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3524 - The item does not allow other items to match that didn't match otherwise,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3525 and that item may extend the match too far. Example for C: A match for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3526 "//" comment can't use "display", because a "/*" inside that comment would
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3527 match then and start a comment which extends past the end of the line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3528
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3529 Examples, for the C language, where "display" can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3530 - match with a number
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3531 - match with a label
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3532
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3533
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3534 transparent *:syn-transparent*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3535
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3536 If the "transparent" argument is given, this item will not be highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3537 itself, but will take the highlighting of the item it is contained in. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3538 is useful for syntax items that don't need any highlighting but are used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3539 only to skip over a part of the text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3540
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3541 The "contains=" argument is also inherited from the item it is contained in,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3542 unless a "contains" argument is given for the transparent item itself. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3543 avoid that unwanted items are contained, use "contains=NONE". Example, which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3544 highlights words in strings, but makes an exception for "vim": >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3545 :syn match myString /'[^']*'/ contains=myWord,myVim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3546 :syn match myWord /\<[a-z]*\>/ contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3547 :syn match myVim /\<vim\>/ transparent contained contains=NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3548 :hi link myString String
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3549 :hi link myWord Comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3550 Since the "myVim" match comes after "myWord" it is the preferred match (last
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3551 match in the same position overrules an earlier one). The "transparent"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3552 argument makes the "myVim" match use the same highlighting as "myString". But
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3553 it does not contain anything. If the "contains=NONE" argument would be left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3554 out, then "myVim" would use the contains argument from myString and allow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3555 "myWord" to be contained, which will be highlighted as a Constant. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3556 happens because a contained match doesn't match inside itself in the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3557 position, thus the "myVim" match doesn't overrule the "myWord" match here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3558
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3559 When you look at the colored text, it is like looking at layers of contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3560 items. The contained item is on top of the item it is contained in, thus you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3561 see the contained item. When a contained item is transparent, you can look
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3562 through, thus you see the item it is contained in. In a picture:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3563
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3564 look from here
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3565
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3566 | | | | | |
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3567 V V V V V V
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3568
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3569 xxxx yyy more contained items
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3570 .................... contained item (transparent)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3571 ============================= first item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3572
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3573 The 'x', 'y' and '=' represent a highlighted syntax item. The '.' represent a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3574 transparent group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3575
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3576 What you see is:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3577
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3578 =======xxxx=======yyy========
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3579
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3580 Thus you look through the transparent "....".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3581
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3582
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3583 oneline *:syn-oneline*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3584
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3585 The "oneline" argument indicates that the region does not cross a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3586 boundary. It must match completely in the current line. However, when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3587 region has a contained item that does cross a line boundary, it continues on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3588 the next line anyway. A contained item can be used to recognize a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3589 continuation pattern. But the "end" pattern must still match in the first
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3590 line, otherwise the region doesn't even start.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3591
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3592 When the start pattern includes a "\n" to match an end-of-line, the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3593 pattern must be found in the same line as where the start pattern ends. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3594 end pattern may also include an end-of-line. Thus the "oneline" argument
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3595 means that the end of the start pattern and the start of the end pattern must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3596 be within one line. This can't be changed by a skip pattern that matches a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3597 line break.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3598
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3599
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3600 fold *:syn-fold*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3601
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3602 The "fold" argument makes the fold level increase by one for this item.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3603 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3604 :syn region myFold start="{" end="}" transparent fold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3605 :syn sync fromstart
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3606 :set foldmethod=syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3607 This will make each {} block form one fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3608
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3609 The fold will start on the line where the item starts, and end where the item
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3610 ends. If the start and end are within the same line, there is no fold.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3611 The 'foldnestmax' option limits the nesting of syntax folds.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3612 {not available when Vim was compiled without |+folding| feature}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3613
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3614
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3615 *:syn-contains* *E405* *E406* *E407* *E408* *E409*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3616 contains={groupname},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3617
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3618 The "contains" argument is followed by a list of syntax group names. These
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3619 groups will be allowed to begin inside the item (they may extend past the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3620 containing group's end). This allows for recursive nesting of matches and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3621 regions. If there is no "contains" argument, no groups will be contained in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3622 this item. The group names do not need to be defined before they can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3623 here.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3624
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3625 contains=ALL
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3626 If the only item in the contains list is "ALL", then all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3627 groups will be accepted inside the item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3628
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3629 contains=ALLBUT,{group-name},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3630 If the first item in the contains list is "ALLBUT", then all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3631 groups will be accepted inside the item, except the ones that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3632 are listed. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3633 :syntax region Block start="{" end="}" ... contains=ALLBUT,Function
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3634
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3635 contains=TOP
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3636 If the first item in the contains list is "TOP", then all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3637 groups will be accepted that don't have the "contained"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3638 argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3639 contains=TOP,{group-name},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3640 Like "TOP", but excluding the groups that are listed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3641
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3642 contains=CONTAINED
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3643 If the first item in the contains list is "CONTAINED", then
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3644 all groups will be accepted that have the "contained"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3645 argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3646 contains=CONTAINED,{group-name},..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3647 Like "CONTAINED", but excluding the groups that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3648 listed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3649
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3650
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3651 The {group-name} in the "contains" list can be a pattern. All group names
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3652 that match the pattern will be included (or excluded, if "ALLBUT" is used).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3653 The pattern cannot contain white space or a ','. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3654 ... contains=Comment.*,Keyw[0-3]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3655 The matching will be done at moment the syntax command is executed. Groups
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3656 that are defined later will not be matched. Also, if the current syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3657 command defines a new group, it is not matched. Be careful: When putting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3658 syntax commands in a file you can't rely on groups NOT being defined, because
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3659 the file may have been sourced before, and ":syn clear" doesn't remove the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3660 group names.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3661
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3662 The contained groups will also match in the start and end patterns of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3663 region. If this is not wanted, the "matchgroup" argument can be used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3664 |:syn-matchgroup|. The "ms=" and "me=" offsets can be used to change the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3665 region where contained items do match. Note that this may also limit the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3666 area that is highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3667
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3668
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3669 containedin={groupname}... *:syn-containedin*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3670
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3671 The "containedin" argument is followed by a list of syntax group names. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3672 item will be allowed to begin inside these groups. This works as if the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3673 containing item has a "contains=" argument that includes this item.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3674
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3675 The {groupname}... can be used just like for "contains", as explained above.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3676
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3677 This is useful when adding a syntax item afterwards. An item can be told to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3678 be included inside an already existing item, without changing the definition
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3679 of that item. For example, to highlight a word in a C comment after loading
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3680 the C syntax: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3681 :syn keyword myword HELP containedin=cComment contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3682 Note that "contained" is also used, to avoid that the item matches at the top
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3683 level.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3684
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3685 Matches for "containedin" are added to the other places where the item can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3686 appear. A "contains" argument may also be added as usual. Don't forget that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3687 keywords never contain another item, thus adding them to "containedin" won't
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3688 work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3689
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3690
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3691 nextgroup={groupname},.. *:syn-nextgroup*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3692
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3693 The "nextgroup" argument is followed by a list of syntax group names,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3694 separated by commas (just like with "contains", so you can also use patterns).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3695
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3696 If the "nextgroup" argument is given, the mentioned syntax groups will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3697 tried for a match, after the match or region ends. If none of the groups have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3698 a match, highlighting continues normally. If there is a match, this group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3699 will be used, even when it is not mentioned in the "contains" field of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3700 current group. This is like giving the mentioned group priority over all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3701 other groups. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3702 :syntax match ccFoobar "Foo.\{-}Bar" contains=ccFoo
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3703 :syntax match ccFoo "Foo" contained nextgroup=ccFiller
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3704 :syntax region ccFiller start="." matchgroup=ccBar end="Bar" contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3705
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3706 This will highlight "Foo" and "Bar" differently, and only when there is a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3707 "Bar" after "Foo". In the text line below, "f" shows where ccFoo is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3708 highlighting, and "bbb" where ccBar is used. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3709
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3710 Foo asdfasd Bar asdf Foo asdf Bar asdf
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3711 fff bbb fff bbb
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3712
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3713 Note the use of ".\{-}" to skip as little as possible until the next Bar.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3714 when ".*" would be used, the "asdf" in between "Bar" and "Foo" would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3715 highlighted according to the "ccFoobar" group, because the ccFooBar match
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3716 would include the first "Foo" and the last "Bar" in the line (see |pattern|).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3717
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3718
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3719 skipwhite *:syn-skipwhite*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3720 skipnl *:syn-skipnl*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3721 skipempty *:syn-skipempty*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3722
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3723 These arguments are only used in combination with "nextgroup". They can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3724 used to allow the next group to match after skipping some text:
1275
d787f6c4c481 updated for version 7.1
vimboss
parents: 1224
diff changeset
3725 skipwhite skip over space and tab characters
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3726 skipnl skip over the end of a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3727 skipempty skip over empty lines (implies a "skipnl")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3728
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3729 When "skipwhite" is present, the white space is only skipped if there is no
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3730 next group that matches the white space.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3731
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3732 When "skipnl" is present, the match with nextgroup may be found in the next
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3733 line. This only happens when the current item ends at the end of the current
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3734 line! When "skipnl" is not present, the nextgroup will only be found after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3735 the current item in the same line.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3736
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3737 When skipping text while looking for a next group, the matches for other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3738 groups are ignored. Only when no next group matches, other items are tried
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3739 for a match again. This means that matching a next group and skipping white
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3740 space and <EOL>s has a higher priority than other items.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3742 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3743 :syn match ifstart "\<if.*" nextgroup=ifline skipwhite skipempty
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3744 :syn match ifline "[^ \t].*" nextgroup=ifline skipwhite skipempty contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3745 :syn match ifline "endif" contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3746 Note that the "[^ \t].*" match matches all non-white text. Thus it would also
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3747 match "endif". Therefore the "endif" match is put last, so that it takes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3748 precedence.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3749 Note that this example doesn't work for nested "if"s. You need to add
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3750 "contains" arguments to make that work (omitted for simplicity of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3751 example).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3752
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3753 IMPLICIT CONCEAL *:syn-conceal-implicit*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3754
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3755 :sy[ntax] conceal [on|off]
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3756 This defines if the following ":syntax" commands will define keywords,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3757 matches or regions with the "conceal" flag set. After ":syn conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3758 on", all subsequent ":syn keyword", ":syn match" or ":syn region"
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3759 defined will have the "conceal" flag set implicitly. ":syn conceal
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3760 off" returns to the normal state where the "conceal" flag must be
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3761 given explicitly.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
3762
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3763 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3764 7. Syntax patterns *:syn-pattern* *E401* *E402*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3765
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3766 In the syntax commands, a pattern must be surrounded by two identical
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3767 characters. This is like it works for the ":s" command. The most common to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3768 use is the double quote. But if the pattern contains a double quote, you can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3769 use another character that is not used in the pattern. Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3770 :syntax region Comment start="/\*" end="\*/"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3771 :syntax region String start=+"+ end=+"+ skip=+\\"+
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3772
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3773 See |pattern| for the explanation of what a pattern is. Syntax patterns are
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3774 always interpreted like the 'magic' option is set, no matter what the actual
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3775 value of 'magic' is. And the patterns are interpreted like the 'l' flag is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3776 not included in 'cpoptions'. This was done to make syntax files portable and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3777 independent of 'compatible' and 'magic' settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3778
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3779 Try to avoid patterns that can match an empty string, such as "[a-z]*".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3780 This slows down the highlighting a lot, because it matches everywhere.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3781
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3782 *:syn-pattern-offset*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3783 The pattern can be followed by a character offset. This can be used to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3784 change the highlighted part, and to change the text area included in the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3785 match or region (which only matters when trying to match other items). Both
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3786 are relative to the matched pattern. The character offset for a skip
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3787 pattern can be used to tell where to continue looking for an end pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3788
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3789 The offset takes the form of "{what}={offset}"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3790 The {what} can be one of seven strings:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3791
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3792 ms Match Start offset for the start of the matched text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3793 me Match End offset for the end of the matched text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3794 hs Highlight Start offset for where the highlighting starts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3795 he Highlight End offset for where the highlighting ends
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3796 rs Region Start offset for where the body of a region starts
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3797 re Region End offset for where the body of a region ends
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3798 lc Leading Context offset past "leading context" of pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3799
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3800 The {offset} can be:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3801
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3802 s start of the matched pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3803 s+{nr} start of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3804 s-{nr} start of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3805 e end of the matched pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3806 e+{nr} end of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the right
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3807 e-{nr} end of the matched pattern plus {nr} chars to the left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3808 {nr} (for "lc" only): start matching {nr} chars to the left
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3809
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3810 Examples: "ms=s+1", "hs=e-2", "lc=3".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3811
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3812 Although all offsets are accepted after any pattern, they are not always
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3813 meaningful. This table shows which offsets are actually used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3814
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3815 ms me hs he rs re lc ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3816 match item yes yes yes yes - - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3817 region item start yes - yes - yes - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3818 region item skip - yes - - - - yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3819 region item end - yes - yes - yes yes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3820
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3821 Offsets can be concatenated, with a ',' in between. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3822 :syn match String /"[^"]*"/hs=s+1,he=e-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3823 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3824 some "string" text
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3825 ^^^^^^ highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3826
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3827 Notes:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3828 - There must be no white space between the pattern and the character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3829 offset(s).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3830 - The highlighted area will never be outside of the matched text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3831 - A negative offset for an end pattern may not always work, because the end
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3832 pattern may be detected when the highlighting should already have stopped.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3833 - Before Vim 7.2 the offsets were counted in bytes instead of characters.
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3834 This didn't work well for multi-byte characters, so it was changed with the
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3835 Vim 7.2 release.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3836 - The start of a match cannot be in a line other than where the pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3837 matched. This doesn't work: "a\nb"ms=e. You can make the highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3838 start in another line, this does work: "a\nb"hs=e.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3839
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3840 Example (match a comment but don't highlight the /* and */): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3841 :syntax region Comment start="/\*"hs=e+1 end="\*/"he=s-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3842 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3843 /* this is a comment */
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3844 ^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^^ highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3845
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3846 A more complicated Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3847 :syn region Exa matchgroup=Foo start="foo"hs=s+2,rs=e+2 matchgroup=Bar end="bar"me=e-1,he=e-1,re=s-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3848 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3849 abcfoostringbarabc
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3850 mmmmmmmmmmm match
625
81fe2ccc1207 updated for version 7.0179
vimboss
parents: 572
diff changeset
3851 sssrrreee highlight start/region/end ("Foo", "Exa" and "Bar")
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3852
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3853 Leading context *:syn-lc* *:syn-leading* *:syn-context*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3854
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3855 Note: This is an obsolete feature, only included for backwards compatibility
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3856 with previous Vim versions. It's now recommended to use the |/\@<=| construct
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3857 in the pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3858
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3859 The "lc" offset specifies leading context -- a part of the pattern that must
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3860 be present, but is not considered part of the match. An offset of "lc=n" will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3861 cause Vim to step back n columns before attempting the pattern match, allowing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3862 characters which have already been matched in previous patterns to also be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3863 used as leading context for this match. This can be used, for instance, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3864 specify that an "escaping" character must not precede the match: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3865
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3866 :syn match ZNoBackslash "[^\\]z"ms=s+1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3867 :syn match WNoBackslash "[^\\]w"lc=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3868 :syn match Underline "_\+"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3869 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3870 ___zzzz ___wwww
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3871 ^^^ ^^^ matches Underline
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3872 ^ ^ matches ZNoBackslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3873 ^^^^ matches WNoBackslash
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3874
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3875 The "ms" offset is automatically set to the same value as the "lc" offset,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3876 unless you set "ms" explicitly.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3877
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3878
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3879 Multi-line patterns *:syn-multi-line*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3880
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3881 The patterns can include "\n" to match an end-of-line. Mostly this works as
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3882 expected, but there are a few exceptions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3883
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3884 When using a start pattern with an offset, the start of the match is not
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3885 allowed to start in a following line. The highlighting can start in a
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3886 following line though. Using the "\zs" item also requires that the start of
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
3887 the match doesn't move to another line.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3888
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3889 The skip pattern can include the "\n", but the search for an end pattern will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3890 continue in the first character of the next line, also when that character is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3891 matched by the skip pattern. This is because redrawing may start in any line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3892 halfway a region and there is no check if the skip pattern started in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3893 previous line. For example, if the skip pattern is "a\nb" and an end pattern
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3894 is "b", the end pattern does match in the second line of this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3895 x x a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3896 b x x
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3897 Generally this means that the skip pattern should not match any characters
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3898 after the "\n".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3899
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3900
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3901 External matches *:syn-ext-match*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3902
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3903 These extra regular expression items are available in region patterns:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3904
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3905 */\z(* */\z(\)* *E50* *E52*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3906 \z(\) Marks the sub-expression as "external", meaning that it is can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3907 be accessed from another pattern match. Currently only usable
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3908 in defining a syntax region start pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3909
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3910 */\z1* */\z2* */\z3* */\z4* */\z5*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3911 \z1 ... \z9 */\z6* */\z7* */\z8* */\z9* *E66* *E67*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3912 Matches the same string that was matched by the corresponding
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3913 sub-expression in a previous start pattern match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3914
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3915 Sometimes the start and end patterns of a region need to share a common
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3916 sub-expression. A common example is the "here" document in Perl and many Unix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3917 shells. This effect can be achieved with the "\z" special regular expression
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3918 items, which marks a sub-expression as "external", in the sense that it can be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3919 referenced from outside the pattern in which it is defined. The here-document
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3920 example, for instance, can be done like this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3921 :syn region hereDoc start="<<\z(\I\i*\)" end="^\z1$"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3922
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3923 As can be seen here, the \z actually does double duty. In the start pattern,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3924 it marks the "\(\I\i*\)" sub-expression as external; in the end pattern, it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3925 changes the \1 back-reference into an external reference referring to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3926 first external sub-expression in the start pattern. External references can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3927 also be used in skip patterns: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3928 :syn region foo start="start \(\I\i*\)" skip="not end \z1" end="end \z1"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3929
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3930 Note that normal and external sub-expressions are completely orthogonal and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3931 indexed separately; for instance, if the pattern "\z(..\)\(..\)" is applied
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3932 to the string "aabb", then \1 will refer to "bb" and \z1 will refer to "aa".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3933 Note also that external sub-expressions cannot be accessed as back-references
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3934 within the same pattern like normal sub-expressions. If you want to use one
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3935 sub-expression as both a normal and an external sub-expression, you can nest
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3936 the two, as in "\(\z(...\)\)".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3937
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3938 Note that only matches within a single line can be used. Multi-line matches
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3939 cannot be referred to.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3940
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3941 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3942 8. Syntax clusters *:syn-cluster* *E400*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3943
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3944 :sy[ntax] cluster {cluster-name} [contains={group-name}..]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3945 [add={group-name}..]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3946 [remove={group-name}..]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3947
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3948 This command allows you to cluster a list of syntax groups together under a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3949 single name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3950
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3951 contains={group-name}..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3952 The cluster is set to the specified list of groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3953 add={group-name}..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3954 The specified groups are added to the cluster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3955 remove={group-name}..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3956 The specified groups are removed from the cluster.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3957
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3958 A cluster so defined may be referred to in a contains=.., containedin=..,
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3959 nextgroup=.., add=.. or remove=.. list with a "@" prefix. You can also use
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
3960 this notation to implicitly declare a cluster before specifying its contents.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3961
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3962 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3963 :syntax match Thing "# [^#]\+ #" contains=@ThingMembers
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3964 :syntax cluster ThingMembers contains=ThingMember1,ThingMember2
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3965
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3966 As the previous example suggests, modifications to a cluster are effectively
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3967 retroactive; the membership of the cluster is checked at the last minute, so
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3968 to speak: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3969 :syntax keyword A aaa
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3970 :syntax keyword B bbb
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3971 :syntax cluster AandB contains=A
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3972 :syntax match Stuff "( aaa bbb )" contains=@AandB
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3973 :syntax cluster AandB add=B " now both keywords are matched in Stuff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3974
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3975 This also has implications for nested clusters: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3976 :syntax keyword A aaa
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3977 :syntax keyword B bbb
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3978 :syntax cluster SmallGroup contains=B
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3979 :syntax cluster BigGroup contains=A,@SmallGroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3980 :syntax match Stuff "( aaa bbb )" contains=@BigGroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3981 :syntax cluster BigGroup remove=B " no effect, since B isn't in BigGroup
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3982 :syntax cluster SmallGroup remove=B " now bbb isn't matched within Stuff
2751
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3983 <
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3984 *E848*
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
3985 The maximum number of clusters is 9767.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3986
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3987 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3988 9. Including syntax files *:syn-include* *E397*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3989
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3990 It is often useful for one language's syntax file to include a syntax file for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3991 a related language. Depending on the exact relationship, this can be done in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3992 two different ways:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3993
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3994 - If top-level syntax items in the included syntax file are to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3995 allowed at the top level in the including syntax, you can simply use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3996 the |:runtime| command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3997
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3998 " In cpp.vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
3999 :runtime! syntax/c.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4000 :unlet b:current_syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4002 < - If top-level syntax items in the included syntax file are to be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4003 contained within a region in the including syntax, you can use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4004 ":syntax include" command:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4005
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4006 :sy[ntax] include [@{grouplist-name}] {file-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4007
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4008 All syntax items declared in the included file will have the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4009 "contained" flag added. In addition, if a group list is specified,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4010 all top-level syntax items in the included file will be added to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4011 that list. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4012
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4013 " In perl.vim:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4014 :syntax include @Pod <sfile>:p:h/pod.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4015 :syntax region perlPOD start="^=head" end="^=cut" contains=@Pod
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4016 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4017 When {file-name} is an absolute path (starts with "/", "c:", "$VAR"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4018 or "<sfile>") that file is sourced. When it is a relative path
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4019 (e.g., "syntax/pod.vim") the file is searched for in 'runtimepath'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4020 All matching files are loaded. Using a relative path is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4021 recommended, because it allows a user to replace the included file
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4022 with his own version, without replacing the file that does the ":syn
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4023 include".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4024
2751
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
4025 *E847*
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
4026 The maximum number of includes is 999.
b0d34143ebfc Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2698
diff changeset
4027
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4028 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4029 10. Synchronizing *:syn-sync* *E403* *E404*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4030
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4031 Vim wants to be able to start redrawing in any position in the document. To
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4032 make this possible it needs to know the syntax state at the position where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4033 redrawing starts.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4034
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4035 :sy[ntax] sync [ccomment [group-name] | minlines={N} | ...]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4036
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4037 There are four ways to synchronize:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4038 1. Always parse from the start of the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4039 |:syn-sync-first|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4040 2. Based on C-style comments. Vim understands how C-comments work and can
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4041 figure out if the current line starts inside or outside a comment.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4042 |:syn-sync-second|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4043 3. Jumping back a certain number of lines and start parsing there.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4044 |:syn-sync-third|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4045 4. Searching backwards in the text for a pattern to sync on.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4046 |:syn-sync-fourth|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4047
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4048 *:syn-sync-maxlines* *:syn-sync-minlines*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4049 For the last three methods, the line range where the parsing can start is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4050 limited by "minlines" and "maxlines".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4051
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4052 If the "minlines={N}" argument is given, the parsing always starts at least
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4053 that many lines backwards. This can be used if the parsing may take a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4054 lines before it's correct, or when it's not possible to use syncing.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4055
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4056 If the "maxlines={N}" argument is given, the number of lines that are searched
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4057 for a comment or syncing pattern is restricted to N lines backwards (after
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4058 adding "minlines"). This is useful if you have few things to sync on and a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4059 slow machine. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4060 :syntax sync ccomment maxlines=500
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4061 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4062 *:syn-sync-linebreaks*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4063 When using a pattern that matches multiple lines, a change in one line may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4064 cause a pattern to no longer match in a previous line. This means has to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4065 start above where the change was made. How many lines can be specified with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4066 the "linebreaks" argument. For example, when a pattern may include one line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4067 break use this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4068 :syntax sync linebreaks=1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4069 The result is that redrawing always starts at least one line before where a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4070 change was made. The default value for "linebreaks" is zero. Usually the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4071 value for "minlines" is bigger than "linebreaks".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4072
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4073
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4074 First syncing method: *:syn-sync-first*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4075 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4076 :syntax sync fromstart
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4077
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4078 The file will be parsed from the start. This makes syntax highlighting
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4079 accurate, but can be slow for long files. Vim caches previously parsed text,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4080 so that it's only slow when parsing the text for the first time. However,
3224
8b8ef1fed009 Update runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3153
diff changeset
4081 when making changes some part of the text needs to be parsed again (worst
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4082 case: to the end of the file).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4083
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4084 Using "fromstart" is equivalent to using "minlines" with a very large number.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4085
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4086
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4087 Second syncing method: *:syn-sync-second* *:syn-sync-ccomment*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4088
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4089 For the second method, only the "ccomment" argument needs to be given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4090 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4091 :syntax sync ccomment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4092
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4093 When Vim finds that the line where displaying starts is inside a C-style
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4094 comment, the last region syntax item with the group-name "Comment" will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4095 used. This requires that there is a region with the group-name "Comment"!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4096 An alternate group name can be specified, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4097 :syntax sync ccomment javaComment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4098 This means that the last item specified with "syn region javaComment" will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4099 used for the detected C comment region. This only works properly if that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4100 region does have a start pattern "\/*" and an end pattern "*\/".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4101
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4102 The "maxlines" argument can be used to restrict the search to a number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4103 lines. The "minlines" argument can be used to at least start a number of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4104 lines back (e.g., for when there is some construct that only takes a few
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4105 lines, but it hard to sync on).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4106
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4107 Note: Syncing on a C comment doesn't work properly when strings are used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4108 that cross a line and contain a "*/". Since letting strings cross a line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4109 is a bad programming habit (many compilers give a warning message), and the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4110 chance of a "*/" appearing inside a comment is very small, this restriction
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4111 is hardly ever noticed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4112
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4113
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4114 Third syncing method: *:syn-sync-third*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4115
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4116 For the third method, only the "minlines={N}" argument needs to be given.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4117 Vim will subtract {N} from the line number and start parsing there. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4118 means {N} extra lines need to be parsed, which makes this method a bit slower.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4119 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4120 :syntax sync minlines=50
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4121
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4122 "lines" is equivalent to "minlines" (used by older versions).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4123
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4124
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4125 Fourth syncing method: *:syn-sync-fourth*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4126
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4127 The idea is to synchronize on the end of a few specific regions, called a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4128 sync pattern. Only regions can cross lines, so when we find the end of some
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4129 region, we might be able to know in which syntax item we are. The search
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4130 starts in the line just above the one where redrawing starts. From there
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4131 the search continues backwards in the file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4132
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4133 This works just like the non-syncing syntax items. You can use contained
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4134 matches, nextgroup, etc. But there are a few differences:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4135 - Keywords cannot be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4136 - The syntax items with the "sync" keyword form a completely separated group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4137 of syntax items. You can't mix syncing groups and non-syncing groups.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4138 - The matching works backwards in the buffer (line by line), instead of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4139 forwards.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4140 - A line continuation pattern can be given. It is used to decide which group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4141 of lines need to be searched like they were one line. This means that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4142 search for a match with the specified items starts in the first of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4143 consecutive that contain the continuation pattern.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4144 - When using "nextgroup" or "contains", this only works within one line (or
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4145 group of continued lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4146 - When using a region, it must start and end in the same line (or group of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4147 continued lines). Otherwise the end is assumed to be at the end of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4148 line (or group of continued lines).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4149 - When a match with a sync pattern is found, the rest of the line (or group of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4150 continued lines) is searched for another match. The last match is used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4151 This is used when a line can contain both the start end the end of a region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4152 (e.g., in a C-comment like /* this */, the last "*/" is used).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4153
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4154 There are two ways how a match with a sync pattern can be used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4155 1. Parsing for highlighting starts where redrawing starts (and where the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4156 search for the sync pattern started). The syntax group that is expected
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4157 to be valid there must be specified. This works well when the regions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4158 that cross lines cannot contain other regions.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4159 2. Parsing for highlighting continues just after the match. The syntax group
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4160 that is expected to be present just after the match must be specified.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4161 This can be used when the previous method doesn't work well. It's much
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4162 slower, because more text needs to be parsed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4163 Both types of sync patterns can be used at the same time.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4164
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4165 Besides the sync patterns, other matches and regions can be specified, to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4166 avoid finding unwanted matches.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4167
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4168 [The reason that the sync patterns are given separately, is that mostly the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4169 search for the sync point can be much simpler than figuring out the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4170 highlighting. The reduced number of patterns means it will go (much)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4171 faster.]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4172
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4173 *syn-sync-grouphere* *E393* *E394*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4174 :syntax sync match {sync-group-name} grouphere {group-name} "pattern" ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4175
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4176 Define a match that is used for syncing. {group-name} is the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4177 name of a syntax group that follows just after the match. Parsing
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4178 of the text for highlighting starts just after the match. A region
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4179 must exist for this {group-name}. The first one defined will be used.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4180 "NONE" can be used for when there is no syntax group after the match.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4181
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4182 *syn-sync-groupthere*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4183 :syntax sync match {sync-group-name} groupthere {group-name} "pattern" ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4184
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4185 Like "grouphere", but {group-name} is the name of a syntax group that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4186 is to be used at the start of the line where searching for the sync
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4187 point started. The text between the match and the start of the sync
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4188 pattern searching is assumed not to change the syntax highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4189 For example, in C you could search backwards for "/*" and "*/". If
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4190 "/*" is found first, you know that you are inside a comment, so the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4191 "groupthere" is "cComment". If "*/" is found first, you know that you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4192 are not in a comment, so the "groupthere" is "NONE". (in practice
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4193 it's a bit more complicated, because the "/*" and "*/" could appear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4194 inside a string. That's left as an exercise to the reader...).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4195
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4196 :syntax sync match ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4197 :syntax sync region ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4198
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4199 Without a "groupthere" argument. Define a region or match that is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4200 skipped while searching for a sync point.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4201
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
4202 *syn-sync-linecont*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4203 :syntax sync linecont {pattern}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4204
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4205 When {pattern} matches in a line, it is considered to continue in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4206 the next line. This means that the search for a sync point will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4207 consider the lines to be concatenated.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4208
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4209 If the "maxlines={N}" argument is given too, the number of lines that are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4210 searched for a match is restricted to N. This is useful if you have very
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4211 few things to sync on and a slow machine. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4212 :syntax sync maxlines=100
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4213
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4214 You can clear all sync settings with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4215 :syntax sync clear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4216
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4217 You can clear specific sync patterns with: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4218 :syntax sync clear {sync-group-name} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4219
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4220 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4221 11. Listing syntax items *:syntax* *:sy* *:syn* *:syn-list*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4222
534
c6296b0ad9ea updated for version 7.0151
vimboss
parents: 523
diff changeset
4223 This command lists all the syntax items: >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4224
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4225 :sy[ntax] [list]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4226
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4227 To show the syntax items for one syntax group: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4228
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4229 :sy[ntax] list {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4230
2581
e8a482a7fa6c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
4231 To list the syntax groups in one cluster: *E392* >
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4232
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4233 :sy[ntax] list @{cluster-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4234
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4235 See above for other arguments for the ":syntax" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4236
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4237 Note that the ":syntax" command can be abbreviated to ":sy", although ":syn"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4238 is mostly used, because it looks better.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4239
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4240 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4241 12. Highlight command *:highlight* *:hi* *E28* *E411* *E415*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4242
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4243 There are three types of highlight groups:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4244 - The ones used for specific languages. For these the name starts with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4245 name of the language. Many of these don't have any attributes, but are
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4246 linked to a group of the second type.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4247 - The ones used for all syntax languages.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4248 - The ones used for the 'highlight' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4249 *hitest.vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4250 You can see all the groups currently active with this command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4251 :so $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/hitest.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4252 This will open a new window containing all highlight group names, displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4253 in their own color.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4254
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4255 *:colo* *:colorscheme* *E185*
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4256 :colo[rscheme] Output the name of the currently active color scheme.
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4257 This is basically the same as >
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4258 :echo g:colors_name
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4259 < In case g:colors_name has not been defined :colo will
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4260 output "default". When compiled without the |+eval|
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4261 feature it will output "unknown".
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4262
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4263 :colo[rscheme] {name} Load color scheme {name}. This searches 'runtimepath'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4264 for the file "colors/{name}.vim. The first one that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4265 is found is loaded.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
4266 To see the name of the currently active color scheme: >
2152
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4267 :colo
b9e314fe473f Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 2033
diff changeset
4268 < The name is also stored in the g:colors_name variable.
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
4269 Doesn't work recursively, thus you can't use
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4270 ":colorscheme" in a color scheme script.
12
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 9
diff changeset
4271 After the color scheme has been loaded the
bdeee1504ac1 updated for version 7.0004
vimboss
parents: 9
diff changeset
4272 |ColorScheme| autocommand event is triggered.
22
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4273 For info about writing a colorscheme file: >
cc049b00ee70 updated for version 7.0014
vimboss
parents: 17
diff changeset
4274 :edit $VIMRUNTIME/colors/README.txt
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4275
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4276 :hi[ghlight] List all the current highlight groups that have
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4277 attributes set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4278
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4279 :hi[ghlight] {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4280 List one highlight group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4281
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4282 :hi[ghlight] clear Reset all highlighting to the defaults. Removes all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4283 highlighting for groups added by the user!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4284 Uses the current value of 'background' to decide which
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4285 default colors to use.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4286
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4287 :hi[ghlight] clear {group-name}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4288 :hi[ghlight] {group-name} NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4289 Disable the highlighting for one highlight group. It
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4290 is _not_ set back to the default colors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4291
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4292 :hi[ghlight] [default] {group-name} {key}={arg} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4293 Add a highlight group, or change the highlighting for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4294 an existing group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4295 See |highlight-args| for the {key}={arg} arguments.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4296 See |:highlight-default| for the optional [default]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4297 argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4298
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4299 Normally a highlight group is added once when starting up. This sets the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4300 default values for the highlighting. After that, you can use additional
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4301 highlight commands to change the arguments that you want to set to non-default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4302 values. The value "NONE" can be used to switch the value off or go back to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4303 the default value.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4304
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4305 A simple way to change colors is with the |:colorscheme| command. This loads
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4306 a file with ":highlight" commands such as this: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4307
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4308 :hi Comment gui=bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4309
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4310 Note that all settings that are not included remain the same, only the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4311 specified field is used, and settings are merged with previous ones. So, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4312 result is like this single command has been used: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4313 :hi Comment term=bold ctermfg=Cyan guifg=#80a0ff gui=bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4314 <
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
4315 *:highlight-verbose*
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4316 When listing a highlight group and 'verbose' is non-zero, the listing will
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4317 also tell where it was last set. Example: >
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4318 :verbose hi Comment
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4319 < Comment xxx term=bold ctermfg=4 guifg=Blue ~
856
8cd729851562 updated for version 7.0g
vimboss
parents: 846
diff changeset
4320 Last set from /home/mool/vim/vim7/runtime/syntax/syncolor.vim ~
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4321
484
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 481
diff changeset
4322 When ":hi clear" is used then the script where this command is used will be
f012c4ed8c38 updated for version 7.0132
vimboss
parents: 481
diff changeset
4323 mentioned for the default values. See |:verbose-cmd| for more information.
448
dd9db57ee7ce updated for version 7.0118
vimboss
parents: 419
diff changeset
4324
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4325 *highlight-args* *E416* *E417* *E423*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4326 There are three types of terminals for highlighting:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4327 term a normal terminal (vt100, xterm)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4328 cterm a color terminal (MS-DOS console, color-xterm, these have the "Co"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4329 termcap entry)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4330 gui the GUI
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4331
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4332 For each type the highlighting can be given. This makes it possible to use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4333 the same syntax file on all terminals, and use the optimal highlighting.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4334
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4335 1. highlight arguments for normal terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4336
301
006e9c8a6a8a updated for version 7.0079
vimboss
parents: 279
diff changeset
4337 *bold* *underline* *undercurl*
006e9c8a6a8a updated for version 7.0079
vimboss
parents: 279
diff changeset
4338 *inverse* *italic* *standout*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4339 term={attr-list} *attr-list* *highlight-term* *E418*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4340 attr-list is a comma separated list (without spaces) of the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4341 following items (in any order):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4342 bold
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4343 underline
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4344 undercurl not always available
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4345 reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4346 inverse same as reverse
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4347 italic
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4348 standout
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4349 NONE no attributes used (used to reset it)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4350
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4351 Note that "bold" can be used here and by using a bold font. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4352 have the same effect.
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4353 "undercurl" is a curly underline. When "undercurl" is not possible
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4354 then "underline" is used. In general "undercurl" is only available in
819
23f82b5d2814 updated for version 7.0c10
vimboss
parents: 816
diff changeset
4355 the GUI. The color is set with |highlight-guisp|.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4356
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4357 start={term-list} *highlight-start* *E422*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4358 stop={term-list} *term-list* *highlight-stop*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4359 These lists of terminal codes can be used to get
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4360 non-standard attributes on a terminal.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4361
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4362 The escape sequence specified with the "start" argument
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4363 is written before the characters in the highlighted
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4364 area. It can be anything that you want to send to the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4365 terminal to highlight this area. The escape sequence
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4366 specified with the "stop" argument is written after the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4367 highlighted area. This should undo the "start" argument.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4368 Otherwise the screen will look messed up.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4369
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4370 The {term-list} can have two forms:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4371
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4372 1. A string with escape sequences.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4373 This is any string of characters, except that it can't start with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4374 "t_" and blanks are not allowed. The <> notation is recognized
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4375 here, so you can use things like "<Esc>" and "<Space>". Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4376 start=<Esc>[27h;<Esc>[<Space>r;
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4377
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4378 2. A list of terminal codes.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4379 Each terminal code has the form "t_xx", where "xx" is the name of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4380 the termcap entry. The codes have to be separated with commas.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4381 White space is not allowed. Example:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4382 start=t_C1,t_BL
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4383 The terminal codes must exist for this to work.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4384
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4385
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4386 2. highlight arguments for color terminals
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4387
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4388 cterm={attr-list} *highlight-cterm*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4389 See above for the description of {attr-list} |attr-list|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4390 The "cterm" argument is likely to be different from "term", when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4391 colors are used. For example, in a normal terminal comments could
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4392 be underlined, in a color terminal they can be made Blue.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4393 Note: Many terminals (e.g., DOS console) can't mix these attributes
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4394 with coloring. Use only one of "cterm=" OR "ctermfg=" OR "ctermbg=".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4395
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4396 ctermfg={color-nr} *highlight-ctermfg* *E421*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4397 ctermbg={color-nr} *highlight-ctermbg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4398 The {color-nr} argument is a color number. Its range is zero to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4399 (not including) the number given by the termcap entry "Co".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4400 The actual color with this number depends on the type of terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4401 and its settings. Sometimes the color also depends on the settings of
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4402 "cterm". For example, on some systems "cterm=bold ctermfg=3" gives
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4403 another color, on others you just get color 3.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4404
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4405 For an xterm this depends on your resources, and is a bit
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4406 unpredictable. See your xterm documentation for the defaults. The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4407 colors for a color-xterm can be changed from the .Xdefaults file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4408 Unfortunately this means that it's not possible to get the same colors
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4409 for each user. See |xterm-color| for info about color xterms.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4410
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4411 The MSDOS standard colors are fixed (in a console window), so these
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4412 have been used for the names. But the meaning of color names in X11
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4413 are fixed, so these color settings have been used, to make the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4414 highlighting settings portable (complicated, isn't it?). The
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4415 following names are recognized, with the color number used:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4416
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4417 *cterm-colors*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4418 NR-16 NR-8 COLOR NAME ~
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4419 0 0 Black
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4420 1 4 DarkBlue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4421 2 2 DarkGreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4422 3 6 DarkCyan
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4423 4 1 DarkRed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4424 5 5 DarkMagenta
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4425 6 3 Brown, DarkYellow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4426 7 7 LightGray, LightGrey, Gray, Grey
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4427 8 0* DarkGray, DarkGrey
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4428 9 4* Blue, LightBlue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4429 10 2* Green, LightGreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4430 11 6* Cyan, LightCyan
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4431 12 1* Red, LightRed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4432 13 5* Magenta, LightMagenta
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4433 14 3* Yellow, LightYellow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4434 15 7* White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4435
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4436 The number under "NR-16" is used for 16-color terminals ('t_Co'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4437 greater than or equal to 16). The number under "NR-8" is used for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4438 8-color terminals ('t_Co' less than 16). The '*' indicates that the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4439 bold attribute is set for ctermfg. In many 8-color terminals (e.g.,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4440 "linux"), this causes the bright colors to appear. This doesn't work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4441 for background colors! Without the '*' the bold attribute is removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4442 If you want to set the bold attribute in a different way, put a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4443 "cterm=" argument AFTER the "ctermfg=" or "ctermbg=" argument. Or use
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4444 a number instead of a color name.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4445
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4446 The case of the color names is ignored.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4447 Note that for 16 color ansi style terminals (including xterms), the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4448 numbers in the NR-8 column is used. Here '*' means 'add 8' so that Blue
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4449 is 12, DarkGray is 8 etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4450
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4451 Note that for some color terminals these names may result in the wrong
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4452 colors!
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4453
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4454 *:hi-normal-cterm*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4455 When setting the "ctermfg" or "ctermbg" colors for the Normal group,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4456 these will become the colors used for the non-highlighted text.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4457 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4458 :highlight Normal ctermfg=grey ctermbg=darkblue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4459 < When setting the "ctermbg" color for the Normal group, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4460 'background' option will be adjusted automatically. This causes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4461 highlight groups that depend on 'background' to change! This means
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4462 you should set the colors for Normal first, before setting other
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4463 colors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4464 When a colorscheme is being used, changing 'background' causes it to
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4465 be reloaded, which may reset all colors (including Normal). First
2033
de5a43c5eedc Update documentation files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@zimbu.org>
parents: 1702
diff changeset
4466 delete the "g:colors_name" variable when you don't want this.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4467
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4468 When you have set "ctermfg" or "ctermbg" for the Normal group, Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4469 needs to reset the color when exiting. This is done with the "op"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4470 termcap entry |t_op|. If this doesn't work correctly, try setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4471 't_op' option in your .vimrc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4472 *E419* *E420*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4473 When Vim knows the normal foreground and background colors, "fg" and
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4474 "bg" can be used as color names. This only works after setting the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4475 colors for the Normal group and for the MS-DOS console. Example, for
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4476 reverse video: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4477 :highlight Visual ctermfg=bg ctermbg=fg
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4478 < Note that the colors are used that are valid at the moment this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4479 command are given. If the Normal group colors are changed later, the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4480 "fg" and "bg" colors will not be adjusted.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4481
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4482
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4483 3. highlight arguments for the GUI
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4484
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4485 gui={attr-list} *highlight-gui*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4486 These give the attributes to use in the GUI mode.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4487 See |attr-list| for a description.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4488 Note that "bold" can be used here and by using a bold font. They
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4489 have the same effect.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4490 Note that the attributes are ignored for the "Normal" group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4491
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4492 font={font-name} *highlight-font*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4493 font-name is the name of a font, as it is used on the system Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4494 runs on. For X11 this is a complicated name, for example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4495 font=-misc-fixed-bold-r-normal--14-130-75-75-c-70-iso8859-1
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4496 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4497 The font-name "NONE" can be used to revert to the default font.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4498 When setting the font for the "Normal" group, this becomes the default
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4499 font (until the 'guifont' option is changed; the last one set is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4500 used).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4501 The following only works with Motif and Athena, not with other GUIs:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4502 When setting the font for the "Menu" group, the menus will be changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4503 When setting the font for the "Tooltip" group, the tooltips will be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4504 changed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4505 All fonts used, except for Menu and Tooltip, should be of the same
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4506 character size as the default font! Otherwise redrawing problems will
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4507 occur.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4508
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4509 guifg={color-name} *highlight-guifg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4510 guibg={color-name} *highlight-guibg*
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4511 guisp={color-name} *highlight-guisp*
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4512 These give the foreground (guifg), background (guibg) and special
642
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4513 (guisp) color to use in the GUI. "guisp" is used for undercurl.
2392a6da4aa4 updated for version 7.0186
vimboss
parents: 632
diff changeset
4514 There are a few special names:
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4515 NONE no color (transparent)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4516 bg use normal background color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4517 background use normal background color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4518 fg use normal foreground color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4519 foreground use normal foreground color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4520 To use a color name with an embedded space or other special character,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4521 put it in single quotes. The single quote cannot be used then.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4522 Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4523 :hi comment guifg='salmon pink'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4524 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4525 *gui-colors*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4526 Suggested color names (these are available on most systems):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4527 Red LightRed DarkRed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4528 Green LightGreen DarkGreen SeaGreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4529 Blue LightBlue DarkBlue SlateBlue
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4530 Cyan LightCyan DarkCyan
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4531 Magenta LightMagenta DarkMagenta
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4532 Yellow LightYellow Brown DarkYellow
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4533 Gray LightGray DarkGray
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4534 Black White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4535 Orange Purple Violet
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4536
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4537 In the Win32 GUI version, additional system colors are available. See
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4538 |win32-colors|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4539
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4540 You can also specify a color by its Red, Green and Blue values.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4541 The format is "#rrggbb", where
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4542 "rr" is the Red value
217
89114a6baf3c updated for version 7.0061
vimboss
parents: 169
diff changeset
4543 "gg" is the Green value
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4544 "bb" is the Blue value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4545 All values are hexadecimal, range from "00" to "ff". Examples: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4546 :highlight Comment guifg=#11f0c3 guibg=#ff00ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4547 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4548 *highlight-groups* *highlight-default*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4549 These are the default highlighting groups. These groups are used by the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4550 'highlight' option default. Note that the highlighting depends on the value
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4551 of 'background'. You can see the current settings with the ":highlight"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4552 command.
2314
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2304
diff changeset
4553 *hl-ColorColumn*
233eb4412f5d Added 'colorcolumn' option. Partly by Gregor Uhlenheuer.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2304
diff changeset
4554 ColorColumn used for the columns set with 'colorcolumn'
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4555 *hl-Conceal*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4556 Conceal placeholder characters substituted for concealed
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4557 text (see 'conceallevel')
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4558 *hl-Cursor*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4559 Cursor the character under the cursor
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4560 *hl-CursorIM*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4561 CursorIM like Cursor, but used when in IME mode |CursorIM|
746
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4562 *hl-CursorColumn*
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4563 CursorColumn the screen column that the cursor is in when 'cursorcolumn' is
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4564 set
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4565 *hl-CursorLine*
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4566 CursorLine the screen line that the cursor is in when 'cursorline' is
0e81c2291705 updated for version 7.0222
vimboss
parents: 720
diff changeset
4567 set
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4568 *hl-Directory*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4569 Directory directory names (and other special names in listings)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4570 *hl-DiffAdd*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4571 DiffAdd diff mode: Added line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4572 *hl-DiffChange*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4573 DiffChange diff mode: Changed line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4574 *hl-DiffDelete*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4575 DiffDelete diff mode: Deleted line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4576 *hl-DiffText*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4577 DiffText diff mode: Changed text within a changed line |diff.txt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4578 *hl-ErrorMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4579 ErrorMsg error messages on the command line
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4580 *hl-VertSplit*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4581 VertSplit the column separating vertically split windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4582 *hl-Folded*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4583 Folded line used for closed folds
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4584 *hl-FoldColumn*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4585 FoldColumn 'foldcolumn'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4586 *hl-SignColumn*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4587 SignColumn column where |signs| are displayed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4588 *hl-IncSearch*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4589 IncSearch 'incsearch' highlighting; also used for the text replaced with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4590 ":s///c"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4591 *hl-LineNr*
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4592 LineNr Line number for ":number" and ":#" commands, and when 'number'
2178
c6f1aa1e9f32 Add 'relativenumber' patch from Markus Heidelberg.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2154
diff changeset
4593 or 'relativenumber' option is set.
3445
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
4594 *hl-CursorLineNr*
2cfb68fa26cd Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 3356
diff changeset
4595 CursorLineNr Like LineNr when 'cursorline' is set for the cursor line.
699
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4596 *hl-MatchParen*
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4597 MatchParen The character under the cursor or just before it, if it
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4598 is a paired bracket, and its match. |pi_paren.txt|
2af8de31a3a8 updated for version 7.0211
vimboss
parents: 677
diff changeset
4599
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4600 *hl-ModeMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4601 ModeMsg 'showmode' message (e.g., "-- INSERT --")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4602 *hl-MoreMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4603 MoreMsg |more-prompt|
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4604 *hl-NonText*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4605 NonText '~' and '@' at the end of the window, characters from
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4606 'showbreak' and other characters that do not really exist in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4607 the text (e.g., ">" displayed when a double-wide character
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4608 doesn't fit at the end of the line).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4609 *hl-Normal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4610 Normal normal text
540
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4611 *hl-Pmenu*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4612 Pmenu Popup menu: normal item.
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4613 *hl-PmenuSel*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4614 PmenuSel Popup menu: selected item.
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4615 *hl-PmenuSbar*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4616 PmenuSbar Popup menu: scrollbar.
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4617 *hl-PmenuThumb*
2df7f3a5eb96 updated for version 7.0153
vimboss
parents: 534
diff changeset
4618 PmenuThumb Popup menu: Thumb of the scrollbar.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4619 *hl-Question*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4620 Question |hit-enter| prompt and yes/no questions
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4621 *hl-Search*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4622 Search Last search pattern highlighting (see 'hlsearch').
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4623 Also used for highlighting the current line in the quickfix
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4624 window and similar items that need to stand out.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4625 *hl-SpecialKey*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4626 SpecialKey Meta and special keys listed with ":map", also for text used
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4627 to show unprintable characters in the text, 'listchars'.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4628 Generally: text that is displayed differently from what it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4629 really is.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4630 *hl-SpellBad*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4631 SpellBad Word that is not recognized by the spellchecker. |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4632 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
391
289b19a6f2ed updated for version 7.0103
vimboss
parents: 301
diff changeset
4633 *hl-SpellCap*
289b19a6f2ed updated for version 7.0103
vimboss
parents: 301
diff changeset
4634 SpellCap Word that should start with a capital. |spell|
289b19a6f2ed updated for version 7.0103
vimboss
parents: 301
diff changeset
4635 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
221
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4636 *hl-SpellLocal*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4637 SpellLocal Word that is recognized by the spellchecker as one that is
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4638 used in another region. |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4639 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4640 *hl-SpellRare*
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4641 SpellRare Word that is recognized by the spellchecker as one that is
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4642 hardly ever used. |spell|
7fd4b5df33be updated for version 7.0062
vimboss
parents: 217
diff changeset
4643 This will be combined with the highlighting used otherwise.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4644 *hl-StatusLine*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4645 StatusLine status line of current window
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4646 *hl-StatusLineNC*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4647 StatusLineNC status lines of not-current windows
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4648 Note: if this is equal to "StatusLine" Vim will use "^^^" in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4649 the status line of the current window.
677
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4650 *hl-TabLine*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4651 TabLine tab pages line, not active tab page label
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4652 *hl-TabLineFill*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4653 TabLineFill tab pages line, where there are no labels
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4654 *hl-TabLineSel*
e649c78407e6 updated for version 7.0202
vimboss
parents: 671
diff changeset
4655 TabLineSel tab pages line, active tab page label
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4656 *hl-Title*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4657 Title titles for output from ":set all", ":autocmd" etc.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4658 *hl-Visual*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4659 Visual Visual mode selection
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4660 *hl-VisualNOS*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4661 VisualNOS Visual mode selection when vim is "Not Owning the Selection".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4662 Only X11 Gui's |gui-x11| and |xterm-clipboard| supports this.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4663 *hl-WarningMsg*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4664 WarningMsg warning messages
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4665 *hl-WildMenu*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4666 WildMenu current match in 'wildmenu' completion
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4667
523
a7ae7e043e43 updated for version 7.0146
vimboss
parents: 501
diff changeset
4668 *hl-User1* *hl-User1..9* *hl-User9*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4669 The 'statusline' syntax allows the use of 9 different highlights in the
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4670 statusline and ruler (via 'rulerformat'). The names are User1 to User9.
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4671
1624
18ee39301b82 updated for version 7.2a
vimboss
parents: 1275
diff changeset
4672 For the GUI you can use the following groups to set the colors for the menu,
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4673 scrollbars and tooltips. They don't have defaults. This doesn't work for the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4674 Win32 GUI. Only three highlight arguments have any effect here: font, guibg,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4675 and guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4676
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4677 *hl-Menu*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4678 Menu Current font, background and foreground colors of the menus.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4679 Also used for the toolbar.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4680 Applicable highlight arguments: font, guibg, guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4681
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4682 NOTE: For Motif and Athena the font argument actually
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4683 specifies a fontset at all times, no matter if 'guifontset' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4684 empty, and as such it is tied to the current |:language| when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4685 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4686
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4687 *hl-Scrollbar*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4688 Scrollbar Current background and foreground of the main window's
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4689 scrollbars.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4690 Applicable highlight arguments: guibg, guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4691
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4692 *hl-Tooltip*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4693 Tooltip Current font, background and foreground of the tooltips.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4694 Applicable highlight arguments: font, guibg, guifg.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4695
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4696 NOTE: For Motif and Athena the font argument actually
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4697 specifies a fontset at all times, no matter if 'guifontset' is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4698 empty, and as such it is tied to the current |:language| when
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4699 set.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4700
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4701 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4702 13. Linking groups *:hi-link* *:highlight-link* *E412* *E413*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4703
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4704 When you want to use the same highlighting for several syntax groups, you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4705 can do this more easily by linking the groups into one common highlight
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4706 group, and give the color attributes only for that group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4707
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4708 To set a link:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4709
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4710 :hi[ghlight][!] [default] link {from-group} {to-group}
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4711
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4712 To remove a link:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4713
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4714 :hi[ghlight][!] [default] link {from-group} NONE
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4715
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4716 Notes: *E414*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4717 - If the {from-group} and/or {to-group} doesn't exist, it is created. You
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4718 don't get an error message for a non-existing group.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4719 - As soon as you use a ":highlight" command for a linked group, the link is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4720 removed.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4721 - If there are already highlight settings for the {from-group}, the link is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4722 not made, unless the '!' is given. For a ":highlight link" command in a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4723 sourced file, you don't get an error message. This can be used to skip
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4724 links for groups that already have settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4725
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4726 *:hi-default* *:highlight-default*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4727 The [default] argument is used for setting the default highlighting for a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4728 group. If highlighting has already been specified for the group the command
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4729 will be ignored. Also when there is an existing link.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4730
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4731 Using [default] is especially useful to overrule the highlighting of a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4732 specific syntax file. For example, the C syntax file contains: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4733 :highlight default link cComment Comment
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4734 If you like Question highlighting for C comments, put this in your vimrc file: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4735 :highlight link cComment Question
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4736 Without the "default" in the C syntax file, the highlighting would be
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4737 overruled when the syntax file is loaded.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4738
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4739 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4740 14. Cleaning up *:syn-clear* *E391*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4741
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4742 If you want to clear the syntax stuff for the current buffer, you can use this
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4743 command: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4744 :syntax clear
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4745
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4746 This command should be used when you want to switch off syntax highlighting,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4747 or when you want to switch to using another syntax. It's normally not needed
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4748 in a syntax file itself, because syntax is cleared by the autocommands that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4749 load the syntax file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4750 The command also deletes the "b:current_syntax" variable, since no syntax is
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4751 loaded after this command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4752
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4753 If you want to disable syntax highlighting for all buffers, you need to remove
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4754 the autocommands that load the syntax files: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4755 :syntax off
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4756
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4757 What this command actually does, is executing the command >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4758 :source $VIMRUNTIME/syntax/nosyntax.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4759 See the "nosyntax.vim" file for details. Note that for this to work
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4760 $VIMRUNTIME must be valid. See |$VIMRUNTIME|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4761
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4762 To clean up specific syntax groups for the current buffer: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4763 :syntax clear {group-name} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4764 This removes all patterns and keywords for {group-name}.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4765
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4766 To clean up specific syntax group lists for the current buffer: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4767 :syntax clear @{grouplist-name} ..
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4768 This sets {grouplist-name}'s contents to an empty list.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4769
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4770 *:syntax-reset* *:syn-reset*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4771 If you have changed the colors and messed them up, use this command to get the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4772 defaults back: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4773
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4774 :syntax reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4775
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4776 This doesn't change the colors for the 'highlight' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4777
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4778 Note that the syntax colors that you set in your vimrc file will also be reset
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4779 back to their Vim default.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4780 Note that if you are using a color scheme, the colors defined by the color
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4781 scheme for syntax highlighting will be lost.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4782
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4783 What this actually does is: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4784
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4785 let g:syntax_cmd = "reset"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4786 runtime! syntax/syncolor.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4787
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4788 Note that this uses the 'runtimepath' option.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4789
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4790 *syncolor*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4791 If you want to use different colors for syntax highlighting, you can add a Vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4792 script file to set these colors. Put this file in a directory in
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4793 'runtimepath' which comes after $VIMRUNTIME, so that your settings overrule
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4794 the default colors. This way these colors will be used after the ":syntax
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4795 reset" command.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4796
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4797 For Unix you can use the file ~/.vim/after/syntax/syncolor.vim. Example: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4798
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4799 if &background == "light"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4800 highlight comment ctermfg=darkgreen guifg=darkgreen
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4801 else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4802 highlight comment ctermfg=green guifg=green
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4803 endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4804
24
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4805 *E679*
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4806 Do make sure this syncolor.vim script does not use a "syntax on", set the
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4807 'background' option or uses a "colorscheme" command, because it results in an
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4808 endless loop.
8ff7fd162d3c updated for version 7.0016
vimboss
parents: 22
diff changeset
4809
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4810 Note that when a color scheme is used, there might be some confusion whether
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4811 your defined colors are to be used or the colors from the scheme. This
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4812 depends on the color scheme file. See |:colorscheme|.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4813
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4814 *syntax_cmd*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4815 The "syntax_cmd" variable is set to one of these values when the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4816 syntax/syncolor.vim files are loaded:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4817 "on" ":syntax on" command. Highlight colors are overruled but
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4818 links are kept
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4819 "enable" ":syntax enable" command. Only define colors for groups that
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4820 don't have highlighting yet. Use ":syntax default".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4821 "reset" ":syntax reset" command or loading a color scheme. Define all
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4822 the colors.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4823 "skip" Don't define colors. Used to skip the default settings when a
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4824 syncolor.vim file earlier in 'runtimepath' has already set
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4825 them.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4826
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4827 ==============================================================================
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4828 15. Highlighting tags *tag-highlight*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4829
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4830 If you want to highlight all the tags in your file, you can use the following
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4831 mappings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4832
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4833 <F11> -- Generate tags.vim file, and highlight tags.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4834 <F12> -- Just highlight tags based on existing tags.vim file.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4835 >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4836 :map <F11> :sp tags<CR>:%s/^\([^ :]*:\)\=\([^ ]*\).*/syntax keyword Tag \2/<CR>:wq! tags.vim<CR>/^<CR><F12>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4837 :map <F12> :so tags.vim<CR>
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4838
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4839 WARNING: The longer the tags file, the slower this will be, and the more
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4840 memory Vim will consume.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4841
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4842 Only highlighting typedefs, unions and structs can be done too. For this you
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4843 must use Exuberant ctags (found at http://ctags.sf.net).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4844
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4845 Put these lines in your Makefile:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4846
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4847 # Make a highlight file for types. Requires Exuberant ctags and awk
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4848 types: types.vim
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4849 types.vim: *.[ch]
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
4850 ctags --c-kinds=gstu -o- *.[ch] |\
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4851 awk 'BEGIN{printf("syntax keyword Type\t")}\
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4852 {printf("%s ", $$1)}END{print ""}' > $@
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4853
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4854 And put these lines in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4855
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4856 " load the types.vim highlighting file, if it exists
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4857 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] let fname = expand('<afile>:p:h') . '/types.vim'
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4858 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] if filereadable(fname)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4859 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] exe 'so ' . fname
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4860 autocmd BufRead,BufNewFile *.[ch] endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4861
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4862 ==============================================================================
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4863 16. Window-local syntax *:ownsyntax*
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4864
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4865 Normally all windows on a buffer share the same syntax settings. It is
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4866 possible, however, to set a particular window on a file to have its own
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4867 private syntax setting. A possible example would be to edit LaTeX source
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4868 with conventional highlighting in one window, while seeing the same source
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4869 highlighted differently (so as to hide control sequences and indicate bold,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4870 italic etc regions) in another. The 'scrollbind' option is useful here.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4871
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4872 To set the current window to have the syntax "foo", separately from all other
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4873 windows on the buffer: >
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4874 :ownsyntax foo
2254
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4875 < *w:current_syntax*
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4876 This will set the "w:current_syntax" variable to "foo". The value of
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4877 "b:current_syntax" does not change. This is implemented by saving and
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4878 restoring "b:current_syntax", since the syntax files do set
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4879 "b:current_syntax". The value set by the syntax file is assigned to
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4880 "w:current_syntax".
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4881
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4882 Once a window has its own syntax, syntax commands executed from other windows
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4883 on the same buffer (including :syntax clear) have no effect. Conversely,
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4884 syntax commands executed from that window do not effect other windows on the
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4885 same buffer.
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4886
2254
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4887 A window with its own syntax reverts to normal behavior when another buffer
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4888 is loaded into that window or the file is reloaded.
4620acaf4814 One more fix for conceal patch.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2250
diff changeset
4889 When splitting the window, the new window will use the original syntax.
2250
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4890
1bac28a53fae Add the conceal patch from Vince Negri.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2236
diff changeset
4891 ==============================================================================
2581
e8a482a7fa6c Updated runtime files.
Bram Moolenaar <bram@vim.org>
parents: 2577
diff changeset
4892 17. Color xterms *xterm-color* *color-xterm*
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4893
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4894 Most color xterms have only eight colors. If you don't get colors with the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4895 default setup, it should work with these lines in your .vimrc: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4896 :if &term =~ "xterm"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4897 : if has("terminfo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4898 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4899 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[3%p1%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4900 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[4%p1%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4901 : else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4902 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4903 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[3%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4904 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[4%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4905 : endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4906 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4907 < [<Esc> is a real escape, type CTRL-V <Esc>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4908
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4909 You might want to change the first "if" to match the name of your terminal,
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4910 e.g. "dtterm" instead of "xterm".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4911
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4912 Note: Do these settings BEFORE doing ":syntax on". Otherwise the colors may
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4913 be wrong.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4914 *xiterm* *rxvt*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4915 The above settings have been mentioned to work for xiterm and rxvt too.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4916 But for using 16 colors in an rxvt these should work with terminfo: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4917 :set t_AB=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t25;%p1%{40}%+%e5;%p1%{32}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4918 :set t_AF=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t22;%p1%{30}%+%e1;%p1%{22}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4919 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4920 *colortest.vim*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4921 To test your color setup, a file has been included in the Vim distribution.
671
83a006f81bac updated for version 7.0199
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
4922 To use it, execute this command: >
83a006f81bac updated for version 7.0199
vimboss
parents: 642
diff changeset
4923 :runtime syntax/colortest.vim
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4924
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4925 Some versions of xterm (and other terminals, like the Linux console) can
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4926 output lighter foreground colors, even though the number of colors is defined
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4927 at 8. Therefore Vim sets the "cterm=bold" attribute for light foreground
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4928 colors, when 't_Co' is 8.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4929
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4930 *xfree-xterm*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4931 To get 16 colors or more, get the newest xterm version (which should be
237
73354c21f1e4 updated for version 7.0066
vimboss
parents: 221
diff changeset
4932 included with XFree86 3.3 and later). You can also find the latest version
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4933 at: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4934 http://invisible-island.net/xterm/xterm.html
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4935 Here is a good way to configure it. This uses 88 colors and enables the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4936 termcap-query feature, which allows Vim to ask the xterm how many colors it
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4937 supports. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4938 ./configure --disable-bold-color --enable-88-color --enable-tcap-query
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4939 If you only get 8 colors, check the xterm compilation settings.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4940 (Also see |UTF8-xterm| for using this xterm with UTF-8 character encoding).
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4941
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4942 This xterm should work with these lines in your .vimrc (for 16 colors): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4943 :if has("terminfo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4944 : set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4945 : set t_AB=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{40}%+%e%p1%{92}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4946 : set t_AF=<Esc>[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{30}%+%e%p1%{82}%+%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4947 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4948 : set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4949 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[3%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4950 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[4%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4951 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4952 < [<Esc> is a real escape, type CTRL-V <Esc>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4953
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4954 Without |+terminfo|, Vim will recognize these settings, and automatically
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4955 translate cterm colors of 8 and above to "<Esc>[9%dm" and "<Esc>[10%dm".
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4956 Colors above 16 are also translated automatically.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4957
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4958 For 256 colors this has been reported to work: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4959
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4960 :set t_AB=<Esc>[48;5;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4961 :set t_AF=<Esc>[38;5;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4962
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4963 Or just set the TERM environment variable to "xterm-color" or "xterm-16color"
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4964 and try if that works.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4965
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4966 You probably want to use these X resources (in your ~/.Xdefaults file):
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4967 XTerm*color0: #000000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4968 XTerm*color1: #c00000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4969 XTerm*color2: #008000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4970 XTerm*color3: #808000
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4971 XTerm*color4: #0000c0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4972 XTerm*color5: #c000c0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4973 XTerm*color6: #008080
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4974 XTerm*color7: #c0c0c0
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4975 XTerm*color8: #808080
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4976 XTerm*color9: #ff6060
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4977 XTerm*color10: #00ff00
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4978 XTerm*color11: #ffff00
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4979 XTerm*color12: #8080ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4980 XTerm*color13: #ff40ff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4981 XTerm*color14: #00ffff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4982 XTerm*color15: #ffffff
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4983 Xterm*cursorColor: Black
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4984
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4985 [Note: The cursorColor is required to work around a bug, which changes the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4986 cursor color to the color of the last drawn text. This has been fixed by a
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
4987 newer version of xterm, but not everybody is using it yet.]
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4988
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4989 To get these right away, reload the .Xdefaults file to the X Option database
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4990 Manager (you only need to do this when you just changed the .Xdefaults file): >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4991 xrdb -merge ~/.Xdefaults
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4992 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4993 *xterm-blink* *xterm-blinking-cursor*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4994 To make the cursor blink in an xterm, see tools/blink.c. Or use Thomas
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4995 Dickey's xterm above patchlevel 107 (see above for where to get it), with
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4996 these resources:
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4997 XTerm*cursorBlink: on
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4998 XTerm*cursorOnTime: 400
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
4999 XTerm*cursorOffTime: 250
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5000 XTerm*cursorColor: White
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5001
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5002 *hpterm-color*
1125
96cd8222a819 updated for version 7.1a
vimboss
parents: 874
diff changeset
5003 These settings work (more or less) for an hpterm, which only supports 8
7
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5004 foreground colors: >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5005 :if has("terminfo")
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5006 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5007 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[&v%p1%dS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5008 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[&v7S
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5009 :else
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5010 : set t_Co=8
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5011 : set t_Sf=<Esc>[&v%dS
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5012 : set t_Sb=<Esc>[&v7S
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5013 :endif
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5014 < [<Esc> is a real escape, type CTRL-V <Esc>]
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5015
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5016 *Eterm* *enlightened-terminal*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5017 These settings have been reported to work for the Enlightened terminal
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5018 emulator, or Eterm. They might work for all xterm-like terminals that use the
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5019 bold attribute to get bright colors. Add an ":if" like above when needed. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5020 :set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5021 :set t_AF=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t3%p1%d%e%p1%{22}%+%d;1%;m
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5022 :set t_AB=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t4%p1%d%e%p1%{32}%+%d;1%;m
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5023 <
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5024 *TTpro-telnet*
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5025 These settings should work for TTpro telnet. Tera Term Pro is a freeware /
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5026 open-source program for MS-Windows. >
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5027 set t_Co=16
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5028 set t_AB=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{40}%+%e%p1%{32}%+5;%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5029 set t_AF=^[[%?%p1%{8}%<%t%p1%{30}%+%e%p1%{22}%+1;%;%dm
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5030 Also make sure TTpro's Setup / Window / Full Color is enabled, and make sure
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5031 that Setup / Font / Enable Bold is NOT enabled.
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5032 (info provided by John Love-Jensen <eljay@Adobe.COM>)
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5033
3fc0f57ecb91 updated for version 7.0001
vimboss
parents:
diff changeset
5034 vim:tw=78:sw=4:ts=8:ft=help:norl: